Merge up to mainline revision 153570.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob129ba7de92748a66bf858c2263960ec53afd0c3d
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
22 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
24 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
25 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
26 out locations for types and decls.
27 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
28 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
31 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
32 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
33 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
34 information. */
36 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
38 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
39 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
40 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
41 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
42 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
44 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
45 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
47 CIE = Common Information Entry
48 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
50 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
52 FDE = Frame Description Entry
53 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
54 how to restore registers
56 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
57 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
59 #include "config.h"
60 #include "system.h"
61 #include "coretypes.h"
62 #include "tm.h"
63 #include "tree.h"
64 #include "version.h"
65 #include "flags.h"
66 #include "real.h"
67 #include "rtl.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
69 #include "regs.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
71 #include "reload.h"
72 #include "function.h"
73 #include "output.h"
74 #include "expr.h"
75 #include "libfuncs.h"
76 #include "except.h"
77 #include "dwarf2.h"
78 #include "dwarf2out.h"
79 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
80 #include "toplev.h"
81 #include "varray.h"
82 #include "ggc.h"
83 #include "md5.h"
84 #include "tm_p.h"
85 #include "diagnostic.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "hashtab.h"
90 #include "cgraph.h"
91 #include "input.h"
92 #include "gimple.h"
93 #include "tree-pass.h"
95 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
96 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
98 static rtx last_var_location_insn;
99 #endif
101 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
102 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
104 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
105 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
106 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
107 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
108 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
109 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
110 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
111 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
112 #else
113 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
114 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
115 #endif
117 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
118 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
119 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
120 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
121 # else
122 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
123 # endif
124 #endif
126 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
127 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
128 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
129 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
130 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
131 #endif
133 /* Save the result of dwarf2out_do_frame across PCH. */
134 static GTY(()) bool saved_do_cfi_asm = 0;
136 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
137 translation unit. */
140 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
142 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
143 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
144 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
145 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
146 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
147 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO || saved_do_cfi_asm
148 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
149 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
150 && (flag_unwind_tables
151 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
152 #endif
156 /* Decide whether to emit frame unwind via assembler directives. */
159 dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm (void)
161 int enc;
163 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
164 return false;
165 #endif
166 if (!flag_dwarf2_cfi_asm || !dwarf2out_do_frame ())
167 return false;
168 if (saved_do_cfi_asm)
169 return true;
170 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_PERSONALITY_DIRECTIVE)
171 return false;
173 /* Make sure the personality encoding is one the assembler can support.
174 In particular, aligned addresses can't be handled. */
175 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,/*global=*/1);
176 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
177 return false;
178 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,/*global=*/0);
179 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
180 return false;
182 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE)
184 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
185 return false;
186 #else
187 if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS || (!flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions))
188 return false;
189 #endif
192 saved_do_cfi_asm = true;
193 return true;
196 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
197 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
198 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
199 #endif
201 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
202 must be kept around forever. */
203 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
205 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
206 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
207 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
208 it. */
209 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
211 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
212 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
213 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
214 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
215 define type declaration DIE's. */
216 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
218 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
219 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
220 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
221 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
222 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
223 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
224 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
225 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
226 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
227 static GTY(()) section *debug_dcall_section;
228 static GTY(()) section *debug_vcall_section;
229 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
230 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
231 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
233 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
234 personality CFI. */
235 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
237 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
238 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
239 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
240 #endif
242 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
243 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
244 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
246 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
247 Information instructions. The register number, offset
248 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
249 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
251 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
252 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
253 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
254 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
255 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
256 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
259 typedef union GTY(()) dw_cfi_oprnd_struct {
260 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
261 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
262 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
263 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
265 dw_cfi_oprnd;
267 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_cfi_struct {
268 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
269 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
270 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
271 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
272 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
273 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
275 dw_cfi_node;
277 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
278 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
279 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
280 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
281 of this structure. */
282 typedef struct GTY(()) cfa_loc {
283 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
284 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
285 unsigned int reg;
286 BOOL_BITFIELD indirect : 1; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
287 BOOL_BITFIELD in_use : 1; /* 1 if a saved cfa is stored here. */
288 } dw_cfa_location;
290 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
291 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
292 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
293 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
294 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
296 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_fde_struct {
297 tree decl;
298 const char *dw_fde_begin;
299 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
300 const char *dw_fde_end;
301 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
302 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
303 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
304 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
305 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
306 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_switch_cfi; /* Last CFI before switching sections. */
307 unsigned funcdef_number;
308 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_realignment;
309 /* Dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
310 unsigned int drap_reg;
311 /* Virtual dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
312 unsigned int vdrap_reg;
313 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
314 unsigned nothrow : 1;
315 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
316 /* Whether we did stack realign in this call frame. */
317 unsigned stack_realign : 1;
318 /* Whether dynamic realign argument pointer register has been saved. */
319 unsigned drap_reg_saved: 1;
320 /* True iff dw_fde_begin label is in text_section or cold_text_section. */
321 unsigned in_std_section : 1;
322 /* True iff dw_fde_unlikely_section_label is in text_section or
323 cold_text_section. */
324 unsigned cold_in_std_section : 1;
325 /* True iff switched sections. */
326 unsigned dw_fde_switched_sections : 1;
327 /* True iff switching from cold to hot section. */
328 unsigned dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot : 1;
330 dw_fde_node;
332 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
333 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
335 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
336 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
337 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
338 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
339 pointers. */
340 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
341 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
342 #endif
344 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
345 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
346 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
347 as PTR_SIZE. */
349 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
350 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
351 #endif
353 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF 4 type signature. */
355 #ifndef DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE
356 #define DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE 8
357 #endif
359 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
360 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
361 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
362 bytes.
364 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
365 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
367 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
368 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
369 #endif
371 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
372 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
373 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
375 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
376 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
377 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
378 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
379 #else
380 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
381 #endif
382 #endif
384 /* CIE identifier. */
385 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
386 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
387 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
388 #else
389 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
390 #endif
392 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
393 information for each routine. */
394 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
396 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
397 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
399 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
400 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
402 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
403 fde_table. */
404 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
406 /* Get the current fde_table entry we should use. */
408 static inline dw_fde_ref
409 current_fde (void)
411 return fde_table_in_use ? &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1] : NULL;
414 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
415 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
417 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
418 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
419 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
420 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
421 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
422 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
423 #endif
425 struct GTY(()) indirect_string_node {
426 const char *str;
427 unsigned int refcount;
428 enum dwarf_form form;
429 char *label;
432 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
434 /* True if the compilation unit has location entries that reference
435 debug strings. */
436 static GTY(()) bool debug_str_hash_forced = false;
438 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
439 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
441 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
442 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
444 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
446 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
447 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
449 /* The default cold text section. */
450 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
452 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
454 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
456 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
457 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
458 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
459 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
460 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
461 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *, dw_cfa_location *);
462 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
463 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
464 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
465 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
466 #endif
467 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
468 HOST_WIDE_INT);
469 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
470 static void output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref);
471 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
472 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
473 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
474 static void dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (HOST_WIDE_INT, const char *);
475 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
476 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx);
477 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
479 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
480 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
481 static void output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref);
482 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
483 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
484 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
485 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
486 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_aligned_loc
487 (HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT);
488 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
490 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
491 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
492 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
493 #endif
495 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
496 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
497 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
499 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
500 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
501 #endif
503 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
504 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
505 #endif
507 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
508 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
509 #endif
511 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
512 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
513 #endif
514 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
515 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
516 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
517 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
518 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
519 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
520 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
521 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
522 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
523 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
525 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
526 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
527 registers. */
528 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
529 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
530 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
531 #else
532 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
533 #endif
534 #endif
536 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
537 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
538 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
539 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
540 #endif
542 /* Hook used by __throw. */
545 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
547 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
548 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
551 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
552 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
554 static inline char *
555 stripattributes (const char *s)
557 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
558 char *p = stripped;
560 *p++ = '*';
562 while (*s && *s != ',')
563 *p++ = *s++;
565 *p = '\0';
566 return stripped;
569 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
570 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
572 static void
573 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode, rtx mem, unsigned int c)
575 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = c * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
576 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
577 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
580 /* Divide OFF by DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, asserting no remainder. */
582 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
583 div_data_align (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
585 HOST_WIDE_INT r = off / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
586 gcc_assert (r * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == off);
587 return r;
590 /* Return true if we need a signed version of a given opcode
591 (e.g. DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf vs DW_CFA_offset_extended). */
593 static inline bool
594 need_data_align_sf_opcode (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
596 return DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT < 0 ? off > 0 : off < 0;
599 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
601 void
602 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
604 unsigned int i;
605 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
606 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
607 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
608 bool wrote_return_column = false;
610 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
612 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
614 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
616 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
617 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
618 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
620 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
621 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
622 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
624 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
625 continue;
626 wrote_return_column = true;
628 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
629 if (offset < 0)
630 continue;
632 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
633 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
637 if (!wrote_return_column)
638 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
640 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
641 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
642 #endif
644 targetm.init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra (address);
647 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
649 static const char *
650 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
652 switch (cfi_opc)
654 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
655 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
656 case DW_CFA_offset:
657 return "DW_CFA_offset";
658 case DW_CFA_restore:
659 return "DW_CFA_restore";
660 case DW_CFA_nop:
661 return "DW_CFA_nop";
662 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
663 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
664 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
665 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
666 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
667 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
668 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
669 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
670 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
671 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
672 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
673 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
674 case DW_CFA_undefined:
675 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
676 case DW_CFA_same_value:
677 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
678 case DW_CFA_register:
679 return "DW_CFA_register";
680 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
681 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
682 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
683 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
684 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
685 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
686 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
687 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
688 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
689 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
691 /* DWARF 3 */
692 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
693 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
694 case DW_CFA_expression:
695 return "DW_CFA_expression";
696 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
697 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
698 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
699 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
700 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
701 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
703 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
704 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
705 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
707 /* GNU extensions */
708 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
709 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
710 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
711 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
712 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
713 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
715 default:
716 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
720 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
722 static inline dw_cfi_ref
723 new_cfi (void)
725 dw_cfi_ref cfi = GGC_NEW (dw_cfi_node);
727 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
728 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
729 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
731 return cfi;
734 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
736 static inline void
737 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
739 dw_cfi_ref *p;
740 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
742 /* When DRAP is used, CFA is defined with an expression. Redefine
743 CFA may lead to a different CFA value. */
744 /* ??? Of course, this heuristic fails when we're annotating epilogues,
745 because of course we'll always want to redefine the CFA back to the
746 stack pointer on the way out. Where should we move this check? */
747 if (0 && fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
748 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
750 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
751 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
752 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
753 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
754 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
755 gcc_unreachable ();
757 default:
758 break;
761 /* Find the end of the chain. */
762 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
765 *p = cfi;
768 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. FORCE is true
769 if a label needs to be output even when using .cfi_* directives. */
771 char *
772 dwarf2out_cfi_label (bool force)
774 static char label[20];
776 if (!force && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
778 /* In this case, we will be emitting the asm directive instead of
779 the label, so just return a placeholder to keep the rest of the
780 interfaces happy. */
781 strcpy (label, "<do not output>");
783 else
785 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
786 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
789 return label;
792 /* True if remember_state should be emitted before following CFI directive. */
793 static bool emit_cfa_remember;
795 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
796 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
798 static void
799 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
801 dw_cfi_ref *list_head;
803 if (emit_cfa_remember)
805 dw_cfi_ref cfi_remember;
807 /* Emit the state save. */
808 emit_cfa_remember = false;
809 cfi_remember = new_cfi ();
810 cfi_remember->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_remember_state;
811 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi_remember);
814 list_head = &cie_cfi_head;
816 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
818 if (label)
820 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
822 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
824 /* We still have to add the cfi to the list so that lookup_cfa
825 works later on. When -g2 and above we even need to force
826 emitting of CFI labels and add to list a DW_CFA_set_loc for
827 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list purposes. If we're generating
828 DWARF3 output we use DW_OP_call_frame_cfa and so don't use
829 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
830 if (dwarf_version == 2
831 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
832 && (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
833 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG))
835 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
837 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
838 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
839 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
840 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
841 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
842 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
843 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
844 if (*label == 0 || strcmp (label, "<do not output>") == 0)
845 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (true);
847 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
848 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
850 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
852 label = xstrdup (label);
854 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
855 xcfi = new_cfi ();
856 /* It doesn't metter whether DW_CFA_set_loc
857 or DW_CFA_advance_loc4 is added here, those aren't
858 emitted into assembly, only looked up by
859 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
860 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_set_loc;
861 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
862 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
863 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
865 break;
866 default:
867 break;
871 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
873 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
875 /* ??? If this is a CFI for the CIE, we don't emit. This
876 assumes that the standard CIE contents that the assembler
877 uses matches the standard CIE contents that the compiler
878 uses. This is probably a bad assumption. I'm not quite
879 sure how to address this for now. */
881 else if (label)
883 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
885 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
887 if (*label == 0)
888 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
890 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
891 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
893 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
895 label = xstrdup (label);
897 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
898 xcfi = new_cfi ();
899 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
900 set the location directly using set_loc. */
901 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
902 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
903 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
904 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
905 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
907 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
910 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
913 add_cfi (list_head, cfi);
916 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
918 static void
919 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc, dw_cfa_location *remember)
921 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
923 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
924 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
925 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
926 break;
927 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
928 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
929 break;
930 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
931 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
932 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
933 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
934 break;
935 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
936 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
937 break;
939 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
940 gcc_assert (!remember->in_use);
941 *remember = *loc;
942 remember->in_use = 1;
943 break;
944 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
945 gcc_assert (remember->in_use);
946 *loc = *remember;
947 remember->in_use = 0;
948 break;
950 default:
951 break;
955 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
957 static void
958 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
960 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
961 dw_fde_ref fde;
962 dw_cfa_location remember;
964 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
965 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
966 remember = *loc;
968 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
969 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
971 fde = current_fde ();
972 if (fde)
973 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
974 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
977 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
978 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
980 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
981 from the CFA. */
982 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
984 /* The current save location around an epilogue. */
985 static dw_cfa_location cfa_remember;
987 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
988 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
990 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
991 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
993 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
994 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
995 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
997 void
998 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1000 dw_cfa_location loc;
1001 loc.indirect = 0;
1002 loc.base_offset = 0;
1003 loc.reg = reg;
1004 loc.offset = offset;
1005 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
1008 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
1010 static bool
1011 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
1013 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
1014 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
1015 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
1016 && (loc1->indirect == 0
1017 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
1020 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
1021 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
1023 static void
1024 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
1026 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1027 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
1029 cfa = *loc_p;
1030 loc = *loc_p;
1032 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
1033 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
1035 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
1036 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
1038 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
1039 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
1040 return;
1042 cfi = new_cfi ();
1044 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
1046 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
1047 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. The data
1048 factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf happens in output_cfi, or
1049 in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa_offset directive. */
1050 if (loc.offset < 0)
1051 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
1052 else
1053 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
1054 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1057 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
1058 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
1059 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
1060 && !loc.indirect)
1062 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
1063 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
1064 offset has not changed. */
1065 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
1066 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1068 #endif
1070 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
1072 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
1073 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
1074 the specified offset. The data factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
1075 happens in output_cfi, or in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa
1076 directive. */
1077 if (loc.offset < 0)
1078 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
1079 else
1080 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
1081 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1082 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1084 else
1086 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
1087 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
1088 register-offset pair is available. */
1089 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
1091 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
1092 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
1093 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
1096 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1099 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
1100 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
1101 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
1102 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
1104 static void
1105 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1107 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1108 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
1110 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1112 /* When stack is aligned, store REG using DW_CFA_expression with
1113 FP. */
1114 if (fde
1115 && fde->stack_realign
1116 && sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1118 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_expression;
1119 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1120 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc
1121 = build_cfa_aligned_loc (offset, fde->stack_realignment);
1123 else if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1125 if (need_data_align_sf_opcode (offset))
1126 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
1127 else if (reg & ~0x3f)
1128 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
1129 else
1130 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
1131 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
1133 else if (sreg == reg)
1134 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
1135 else
1137 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
1138 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
1141 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1144 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
1145 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
1146 from the previous frame's window save area.
1148 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
1149 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
1151 void
1152 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
1154 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1156 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
1157 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1160 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
1161 pushed onto the stack. */
1163 void
1164 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1166 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1168 if (size == old_args_size)
1169 return;
1171 old_args_size = size;
1173 cfi = new_cfi ();
1174 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
1175 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
1176 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1179 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
1180 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1182 void
1183 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1185 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1188 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
1189 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1191 void
1192 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1194 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1197 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
1198 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
1200 void
1201 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
1203 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
1206 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
1207 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
1208 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
1210 static void
1211 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
1213 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1214 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1216 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1218 case REG:
1219 /* RA is in a register. */
1220 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
1221 break;
1223 case MEM:
1224 /* RA is on the stack. */
1225 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
1226 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1228 case REG:
1229 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1230 offset = 0;
1231 break;
1233 case PLUS:
1234 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1235 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1236 break;
1238 case MINUS:
1239 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1240 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1241 break;
1243 default:
1244 gcc_unreachable ();
1247 break;
1249 case PLUS:
1250 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1251 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1252 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1253 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
1254 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1255 return;
1257 default:
1258 gcc_unreachable ();
1261 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1262 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1264 #endif
1266 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1267 contains. */
1269 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1270 stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx pattern, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1271 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_offset)
1273 const_rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1274 const_rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1275 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1276 enum rtx_code code;
1278 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1280 code = GET_CODE (src);
1282 /* Assume (set (reg sp) (reg whatever)) sets args_size
1283 level to 0. */
1284 if (code == REG && src != stack_pointer_rtx)
1286 offset = -cur_args_size;
1287 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1288 offset = -offset;
1289 #endif
1290 return offset - cur_offset;
1293 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1294 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1295 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
1296 return 0;
1298 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1299 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1300 if (code == PLUS)
1301 offset = -offset;
1302 return offset;
1305 if (MEM_P (src) && !MEM_P (dest))
1306 dest = src;
1307 if (MEM_P (dest))
1309 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1310 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1311 code = GET_CODE (src);
1313 switch (code)
1315 case PRE_MODIFY:
1316 case POST_MODIFY:
1317 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1319 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1320 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1321 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1322 && CONST_INT_P (val));
1323 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1324 break;
1326 return 0;
1328 case PRE_DEC:
1329 case POST_DEC:
1330 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1332 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1333 break;
1335 return 0;
1337 case PRE_INC:
1338 case POST_INC:
1339 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1341 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1342 break;
1344 return 0;
1346 default:
1347 return 0;
1350 else
1351 return 0;
1353 return offset;
1356 /* Precomputed args_size for CODE_LABELs and BARRIERs preceeding them,
1357 indexed by INSN_UID. */
1359 static HOST_WIDE_INT *barrier_args_size;
1361 /* Helper function for compute_barrier_args_size. Handle one insn. */
1363 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1364 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1365 VEC (rtx, heap) **next)
1367 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1368 int i;
1370 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1372 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1373 /* Nothing */;
1374 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1375 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), cur_args_size, 0);
1376 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1377 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1379 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1380 for them. */
1381 for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1382 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1383 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1384 cur_args_size, offset);
1387 else
1389 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1391 if (expr)
1393 expr = XEXP (expr, 0);
1394 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL
1395 || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1396 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (expr, 0); i++)
1398 rtx elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, i);
1400 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
1401 offset += stack_adjust_offset (elem, cur_args_size, offset);
1406 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1407 offset = -offset;
1408 #endif
1410 cur_args_size += offset;
1411 if (cur_args_size < 0)
1412 cur_args_size = 0;
1414 if (JUMP_P (insn))
1416 rtx dest = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
1418 if (dest)
1420 if (barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] < 0)
1422 barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] = cur_args_size;
1423 VEC_safe_push (rtx, heap, *next, dest);
1428 return cur_args_size;
1431 /* Walk the whole function and compute args_size on BARRIERs. */
1433 static void
1434 compute_barrier_args_size (void)
1436 int max_uid = get_max_uid (), i;
1437 rtx insn;
1438 VEC (rtx, heap) *worklist, *next, *tmp;
1440 barrier_args_size = XNEWVEC (HOST_WIDE_INT, max_uid);
1441 for (i = 0; i < max_uid; i++)
1442 barrier_args_size[i] = -1;
1444 worklist = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1445 next = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1446 insn = get_insns ();
1447 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = 0;
1448 VEC_quick_push (rtx, worklist, insn);
1449 for (;;)
1451 while (!VEC_empty (rtx, worklist))
1453 rtx prev, body, first_insn;
1454 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size;
1456 first_insn = insn = VEC_pop (rtx, worklist);
1457 cur_args_size = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1458 prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
1459 if (prev && BARRIER_P (prev))
1460 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (prev)] = cur_args_size;
1462 for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1464 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
1465 continue;
1466 if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1467 break;
1469 if (LABEL_P (insn))
1471 if (insn == first_insn)
1472 continue;
1473 else if (barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] < 0)
1475 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = cur_args_size;
1476 continue;
1478 else
1480 /* The insns starting with this label have been
1481 already scanned or are in the worklist. */
1482 break;
1486 body = PATTERN (insn);
1487 if (GET_CODE (body) == SEQUENCE)
1489 HOST_WIDE_INT dest_args_size = cur_args_size;
1490 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (body, 0); i++)
1491 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0))
1492 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)))
1493 dest_args_size
1494 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1495 dest_args_size, &next);
1496 else
1497 cur_args_size
1498 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1499 cur_args_size, &next);
1501 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0)))
1502 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1503 dest_args_size, &next);
1504 else
1505 cur_args_size
1506 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1507 cur_args_size, &next);
1509 else
1510 cur_args_size
1511 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (insn, cur_args_size, &next);
1515 if (VEC_empty (rtx, next))
1516 break;
1518 /* Swap WORKLIST with NEXT and truncate NEXT for next iteration. */
1519 tmp = next;
1520 next = worklist;
1521 worklist = tmp;
1522 VEC_truncate (rtx, next, 0);
1525 VEC_free (rtx, heap, worklist);
1526 VEC_free (rtx, heap, next);
1530 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1531 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1532 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1534 static void
1535 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1537 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1538 const char *label;
1539 int i;
1541 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1542 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1543 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1544 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1545 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1546 return;
1548 /* If INSN is an instruction from target of an annulled branch, the
1549 effects are for the target only and so current argument size
1550 shouldn't change at all. */
1551 if (final_sequence
1552 && INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0))
1553 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (insn))
1554 return;
1556 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1557 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1558 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1560 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1562 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1563 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1564 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1565 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1566 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1567 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1568 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1569 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1571 return;
1574 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1576 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1577 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1578 return;
1580 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1582 /* Don't call compute_barrier_args_size () if the only
1583 BARRIER is at the end of function. */
1584 if (barrier_args_size == NULL && next_nonnote_insn (insn))
1585 compute_barrier_args_size ();
1586 if (barrier_args_size == NULL)
1587 offset = 0;
1588 else
1590 offset = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1591 if (offset < 0)
1592 offset = 0;
1595 offset -= args_size;
1596 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1597 offset = -offset;
1598 #endif
1600 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1601 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), args_size, 0);
1602 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1603 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1605 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1606 for them. */
1607 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1608 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1609 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1610 args_size, offset);
1612 else
1613 return;
1615 if (offset == 0)
1616 return;
1618 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
1619 dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (offset, label);
1622 /* Adjust args_size based on stack adjustment OFFSET. */
1624 static void
1625 dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, const char *label)
1627 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1628 cfa.offset += offset;
1630 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1631 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1633 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1634 offset = -offset;
1635 #endif
1637 args_size += offset;
1638 if (args_size < 0)
1639 args_size = 0;
1641 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1642 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1643 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1646 #endif
1648 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1649 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1650 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1652 struct GTY(()) queued_reg_save {
1653 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1654 rtx reg;
1655 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1656 rtx saved_reg;
1659 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1661 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1662 struct GTY(()) reg_saved_in_data {
1663 rtx orig_reg;
1664 rtx saved_in_reg;
1667 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1668 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1669 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1670 more efficient data structure. */
1671 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1672 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1674 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1675 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1677 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1678 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1680 static void
1681 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1683 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1685 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1686 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1687 order. */
1688 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1689 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1690 break;
1692 if (q == NULL)
1694 q = GGC_NEW (struct queued_reg_save);
1695 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1696 queued_reg_saves = q;
1699 q->reg = reg;
1700 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1701 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1703 last_reg_save_label = label;
1706 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1708 static void
1709 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1711 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1713 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1715 size_t i;
1716 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1718 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1719 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1720 break;
1721 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1723 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1724 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1726 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1728 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1729 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1732 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1733 if (q->saved_reg)
1734 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1735 else
1736 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1737 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1740 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1741 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1744 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1745 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1746 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1747 have a new location for? */
1749 static bool
1750 clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx insn)
1752 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1754 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1756 size_t i;
1757 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1758 return true;
1759 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1760 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1761 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1762 return true;
1765 return false;
1768 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1770 void
1771 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1773 size_t i;
1774 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1776 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1777 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1778 break;
1779 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1781 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1782 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1784 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1785 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1787 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1788 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1789 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1792 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1794 static rtx
1795 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1797 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1798 size_t i;
1799 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1801 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1802 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1803 return q->reg;
1805 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1806 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1807 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1808 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1810 return NULL_RTX;
1814 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1815 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1816 value, not an offset. */
1817 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1819 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_DEF_CFA note. */
1821 static void
1822 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1824 memset (&cfa, 0, sizeof (cfa));
1826 switch (GET_CODE (pat))
1828 case PLUS:
1829 cfa.reg = REGNO (XEXP (pat, 0));
1830 cfa.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (pat, 1));
1831 break;
1833 case REG:
1834 cfa.reg = REGNO (pat);
1835 break;
1837 default:
1838 /* Recurse and define an expression. */
1839 gcc_unreachable ();
1842 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1845 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_ADJUST_CFA note. */
1847 static void
1848 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1850 rtx src, dest;
1852 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pat) == SET);
1853 dest = XEXP (pat, 0);
1854 src = XEXP (pat, 1);
1856 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1858 case PLUS:
1859 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1860 cfa.offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1861 break;
1863 case REG:
1864 break;
1866 default:
1867 gcc_unreachable ();
1870 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1871 gcc_assert (cfa.indirect == 0);
1873 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1876 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_OFFSET note. */
1878 static void
1879 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (rtx set, const char *label)
1881 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1882 rtx src, addr, span;
1884 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1885 addr = XEXP (set, 0);
1886 gcc_assert (MEM_P (addr));
1887 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
1889 /* As documented, only consider extremely simple addresses. */
1890 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
1892 case REG:
1893 gcc_assert (REGNO (addr) == cfa.reg);
1894 offset = -cfa.offset;
1895 break;
1896 case PLUS:
1897 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (addr, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1898 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1)) - cfa.offset;
1899 break;
1900 default:
1901 gcc_unreachable ();
1904 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
1906 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1907 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1908 if (!span)
1909 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src)), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1910 else
1912 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC live.
1913 Queue register saves for each piece of the PARALLEL. */
1914 int par_index;
1915 int limit;
1916 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
1918 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
1920 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
1921 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1923 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
1925 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (elem)),
1926 INVALID_REGNUM, span_offset);
1927 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
1932 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_REGISTER note. */
1934 static void
1935 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (rtx set, const char *label)
1937 rtx src, dest;
1938 unsigned sregno, dregno;
1940 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1941 dest = XEXP (set, 0);
1943 if (src == pc_rtx)
1944 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
1945 else
1946 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
1948 dregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
1950 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1951 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1952 reg_save (label, sregno, dregno, 0);
1955 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_RESTORE note. */
1957 static void
1958 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (rtx reg, const char *label)
1960 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1961 unsigned int regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1963 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = (regno & ~0x3f ? DW_CFA_restore_extended : DW_CFA_restore);
1964 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = regno;
1966 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1969 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1970 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1971 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1972 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1974 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1975 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1976 users need not read the source code.
1978 The High-Level Picture
1980 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1981 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1982 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1983 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1984 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1986 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1987 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1988 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1989 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1990 saves. This also seems to work.
1992 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1993 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1994 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1995 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1996 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1997 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1998 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1999 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
2000 value as in the caller.
2002 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
2003 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
2004 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
2005 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
2007 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
2008 register,
2010 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
2012 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
2013 consists of a register and an offset.
2014 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
2015 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
2016 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
2017 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
2018 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
2019 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
2020 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
2022 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
2023 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
2024 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
2025 cfa_temp.offset.
2027 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
2028 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
2029 and cfa_temp.offset.
2031 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
2032 stack.
2034 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
2035 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
2036 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
2038 Rules 16-20: If AND operation happens on sp in prologue, we assume
2039 stack is realigned. We will use a group of DW_OP_XXX
2040 expressions to represent the location of the stored
2041 register instead of CFA+offset.
2043 The Rules
2045 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
2046 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
2048 Rule 1:
2049 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
2050 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2051 cfa.offset unchanged
2052 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2053 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2055 Rule 2:
2056 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
2057 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
2058 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
2059 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
2060 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
2061 if cfa_store.reg==sp
2063 Rule 3:
2064 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2065 effects: cfa.reg = fp
2066 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
2068 Rule 4:
2069 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2070 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2071 <reg1> != sp
2072 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2073 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2074 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2076 Rule 5:
2077 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
2078 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2079 <reg1> != sp
2080 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
2081 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
2083 Rule 6:
2084 (set <reg> <const_int>)
2085 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2086 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2088 Rule 7:
2089 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
2090 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2091 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
2093 Rule 8:
2094 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
2095 effects: none
2097 Rule 9:
2098 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
2099 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2100 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2102 Rule 10:
2103 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
2104 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
2105 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2106 cfa.reg = sp
2107 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2109 Rule 11:
2110 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
2111 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2112 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2113 cfa.reg = sp
2114 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2116 Rule 12:
2117 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
2119 <reg2>)
2120 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2121 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2123 Rule 13:
2124 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
2125 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2126 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2128 Rule 14:
2129 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
2130 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2131 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
2132 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
2134 Rule 15:
2135 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
2136 effects: target-dependent
2138 Rule 16:
2139 (set sp (and: sp <const_int>))
2140 constraints: cfa_store.reg == sp
2141 effects: current_fde.stack_realign = 1
2142 cfa_store.offset = 0
2143 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg if cfa.reg != sp and cfa.reg != fp
2145 Rule 17:
2146 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) (mem (plus (cfa.reg) (const_int))))
2147 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2149 Rule 18:
2150 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) fp)
2151 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2152 effects: cfa_store.offset = 0
2153 cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2155 Rule 19:
2156 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) cfa.reg)
2157 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2158 && cfa.offset == 0
2159 && cfa.indirect == 0
2160 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2161 effects: Use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression to define cfa
2162 cfa.reg == fde->drap_reg
2164 Rule 20:
2165 (set reg fde->drap_reg)
2166 constraints: fde->vdrap_reg == INVALID_REGNUM
2167 effects: fde->vdrap_reg = reg.
2168 (set mem fde->drap_reg)
2169 constraints: fde->drap_reg_saved == 1
2170 effects: none. */
2172 static void
2173 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
2175 rtx src, dest, span;
2176 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
2177 dw_fde_ref fde;
2179 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
2180 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
2181 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
2182 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
2183 flag is set in them. */
2184 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2186 int par_index;
2187 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
2188 rtx elem;
2190 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
2191 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
2192 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
2193 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
2194 handle register saves before register assignments. */
2195 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL)
2196 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2198 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2199 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2200 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem))
2201 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2202 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2205 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2207 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2208 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2209 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem)) || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2210 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2211 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2212 else if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2213 && par_index != 0
2214 && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
2216 /* Stack adjustment combining might combine some post-prologue
2217 stack adjustment into a prologue stack adjustment. */
2218 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = stack_adjust_offset (elem, args_size, 0);
2220 if (offset != 0)
2221 dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (offset, label);
2224 return;
2227 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
2229 src = SET_SRC (expr);
2230 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
2232 if (REG_P (src))
2234 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
2235 if (rsi)
2236 src = rsi;
2239 fde = current_fde ();
2241 if (REG_P (src)
2242 && fde
2243 && fde->drap_reg == REGNO (src)
2244 && (fde->drap_reg_saved
2245 || REG_P (dest)))
2247 /* Rule 20 */
2248 /* If we are saving dynamic realign argument pointer to a
2249 register, the destination is virtual dynamic realign
2250 argument pointer. It may be used to access argument. */
2251 if (REG_P (dest))
2253 gcc_assert (fde->vdrap_reg == INVALID_REGNUM);
2254 fde->vdrap_reg = REGNO (dest);
2256 return;
2259 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
2261 case REG:
2262 switch (GET_CODE (src))
2264 /* Setting FP from SP. */
2265 case REG:
2266 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
2268 /* Rule 1 */
2269 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
2270 relative to the current CFA register.
2272 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
2273 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
2274 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
2275 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
2276 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2277 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2278 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2280 else
2282 /* Saving a register in a register. */
2283 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
2284 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
2285 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
2286 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
2288 /* After stack is aligned, we can only save SP in FP
2289 if drap register is used. In this case, we have
2290 to restore stack pointer with the CFA value and we
2291 don't generate this DWARF information. */
2292 if (fde
2293 && fde->stack_realign
2294 && REGNO (src) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2295 gcc_assert (REGNO (dest) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2296 && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM
2297 && cfa.reg != REGNO (src));
2298 else
2299 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
2301 break;
2303 case PLUS:
2304 case MINUS:
2305 case LO_SUM:
2306 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
2308 /* Rule 2 */
2309 /* Adjusting SP. */
2310 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
2312 case CONST_INT:
2313 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2314 break;
2315 case REG:
2316 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
2317 == cfa_temp.reg);
2318 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
2319 break;
2320 default:
2321 gcc_unreachable ();
2324 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2326 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
2327 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2328 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2330 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
2331 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
2333 else
2334 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
2336 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2337 offset = -offset;
2338 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2339 cfa.offset += offset;
2340 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2341 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2343 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2345 /* Rule 3 */
2346 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
2347 or adjusting the FP */
2348 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
2350 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2351 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2352 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2353 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2354 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2355 offset = -offset;
2356 cfa.offset += offset;
2357 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2359 else
2361 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
2363 /* Rule 4 */
2364 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2365 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2366 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2368 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
2369 into the FP later on. */
2370 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2371 cfa.offset += offset;
2372 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2373 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
2374 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2375 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2378 /* Rule 5 */
2379 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2380 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2381 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2383 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
2384 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
2385 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2386 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
2387 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
2390 /* Rule 9 */
2391 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
2392 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2394 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2395 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2397 else
2398 gcc_unreachable ();
2400 break;
2402 /* Rule 6 */
2403 case CONST_INT:
2404 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2405 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
2406 break;
2408 /* Rule 7 */
2409 case IOR:
2410 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2411 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2412 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2414 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
2415 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2416 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2417 break;
2419 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
2420 which will fill in all of the bits. */
2421 /* Rule 8 */
2422 case HIGH:
2423 break;
2425 /* Rule 15 */
2426 case UNSPEC:
2427 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
2428 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
2429 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
2430 return;
2432 /* Rule 16 */
2433 case AND:
2434 /* If this AND operation happens on stack pointer in prologue,
2435 we assume the stack is realigned and we extract the
2436 alignment. */
2437 if (fde && XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2439 gcc_assert (cfa_store.reg == REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)));
2440 fde->stack_realign = 1;
2441 fde->stack_realignment = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2442 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2444 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2445 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2446 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg;
2448 return;
2450 default:
2451 gcc_unreachable ();
2454 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2455 break;
2457 case MEM:
2459 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
2460 CFA register. */
2461 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
2463 /* Rule 10 */
2464 /* With a push. */
2465 case PRE_MODIFY:
2466 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
2467 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
2468 == CONST_INT);
2469 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
2471 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2472 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2474 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2475 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2476 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2478 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2479 break;
2481 /* Rule 11 */
2482 case PRE_INC:
2483 case PRE_DEC:
2484 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2485 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
2486 offset = -offset;
2488 gcc_assert ((REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0))
2489 == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2490 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2492 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2494 /* Rule 18: If stack is aligned, we will use FP as a
2495 reference to represent the address of the stored
2496 regiser. */
2497 if (fde
2498 && fde->stack_realign
2499 && src == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2501 gcc_assert (cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2502 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2505 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2506 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2508 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2509 break;
2511 /* Rule 12 */
2512 /* With an offset. */
2513 case PLUS:
2514 case MINUS:
2515 case LO_SUM:
2517 int regno;
2519 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1))
2520 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2521 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
2522 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
2523 offset = -offset;
2525 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
2527 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2528 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
2529 else
2531 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2532 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
2535 break;
2537 /* Rule 13 */
2538 /* Without an offset. */
2539 case REG:
2541 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
2543 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2544 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2545 else
2547 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2548 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2551 break;
2553 /* Rule 14 */
2554 case POST_INC:
2555 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
2556 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2557 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2558 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2559 break;
2561 default:
2562 gcc_unreachable ();
2565 /* Rule 17 */
2566 /* If the source operand of this MEM operation is not a
2567 register, basically the source is return address. Here
2568 we only care how much stack grew and we don't save it. */
2569 if (!REG_P (src))
2570 break;
2572 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2573 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2574 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
2576 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
2578 if (cfa.offset == 0)
2580 /* Rule 19 */
2581 /* If stack is aligned, putting CFA reg into stack means
2582 we can no longer use reg + offset to represent CFA.
2583 Here we use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instead. The
2584 result of this expression equals to the original CFA
2585 value. */
2586 if (fde
2587 && fde->stack_realign
2588 && cfa.indirect == 0
2589 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2591 dw_cfa_location cfa_exp;
2593 gcc_assert (fde->drap_reg == cfa.reg);
2595 cfa_exp.indirect = 1;
2596 cfa_exp.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2597 cfa_exp.base_offset = offset;
2598 cfa_exp.offset = 0;
2600 fde->drap_reg_saved = 1;
2602 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa_exp);
2603 break;
2606 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
2607 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
2608 on the ARM. */
2609 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2610 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
2611 break;
2613 else
2615 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
2616 calculate the CFA. */
2617 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
2619 if (!REG_P (x))
2620 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2621 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
2623 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
2624 cfa.base_offset = offset;
2625 cfa.indirect = 1;
2626 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2627 break;
2631 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2633 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
2635 if (!span)
2636 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
2637 else
2639 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC
2640 live. Queue register saves for each piece of the
2641 PARALLEL. */
2642 int par_index;
2643 int limit;
2644 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
2646 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
2648 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
2649 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2651 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
2653 queue_reg_save (label, elem, NULL_RTX, span_offset);
2654 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
2658 break;
2660 default:
2661 gcc_unreachable ();
2665 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
2666 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
2667 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
2669 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
2670 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
2672 void
2673 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
2675 const char *label;
2676 rtx note, n;
2677 bool handled_one = false;
2679 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
2681 size_t i;
2683 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
2684 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2686 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
2687 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
2688 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
2689 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
2691 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2692 cfa_store = cfa;
2693 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
2694 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
2696 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
2698 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
2699 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
2701 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
2703 if (barrier_args_size)
2705 XDELETEVEC (barrier_args_size);
2706 barrier_args_size = NULL;
2708 return;
2711 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
2712 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2714 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
2716 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
2717 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
2718 return;
2721 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2723 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
2724 switch (REG_NOTE_KIND (note))
2726 case REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR:
2727 insn = XEXP (note, 0);
2728 goto found;
2730 case REG_CFA_DEF_CFA:
2731 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (XEXP (note, 0), label);
2732 handled_one = true;
2733 break;
2735 case REG_CFA_ADJUST_CFA:
2736 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2737 if (n == NULL)
2739 n = PATTERN (insn);
2740 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2741 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2743 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (n, label);
2744 handled_one = true;
2745 break;
2747 case REG_CFA_OFFSET:
2748 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2749 if (n == NULL)
2750 n = single_set (insn);
2751 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (n, label);
2752 handled_one = true;
2753 break;
2755 case REG_CFA_REGISTER:
2756 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2757 if (n == NULL)
2759 n = PATTERN (insn);
2760 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2761 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2763 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (n, label);
2764 handled_one = true;
2765 break;
2767 case REG_CFA_RESTORE:
2768 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2769 if (n == NULL)
2771 n = PATTERN (insn);
2772 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2773 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2774 n = XEXP (n, 0);
2776 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (n, label);
2777 handled_one = true;
2778 break;
2780 default:
2781 break;
2783 if (handled_one)
2784 return;
2786 insn = PATTERN (insn);
2787 found:
2788 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
2791 /* Determine if we need to save and restore CFI information around this
2792 epilogue. If SIBCALL is true, then this is a sibcall epilogue. If
2793 we do need to save/restore, then emit the save now, and insert a
2794 NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE at the appropriate place in the stream. */
2796 void
2797 dwarf2out_begin_epilogue (rtx insn)
2799 bool saw_frp = false;
2800 rtx i;
2802 /* Scan forward to the return insn, noticing if there are possible
2803 frame related insns. */
2804 for (i = NEXT_INSN (insn); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
2806 if (!INSN_P (i))
2807 continue;
2809 /* Look for both regular and sibcalls to end the block. */
2810 if (returnjump_p (i))
2811 break;
2812 if (CALL_P (i) && SIBLING_CALL_P (i))
2813 break;
2815 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == SEQUENCE)
2817 int idx;
2818 rtx seq = PATTERN (i);
2820 if (returnjump_p (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2821 break;
2822 if (CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0))
2823 && SIBLING_CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2824 break;
2826 for (idx = 0; idx < XVECLEN (seq, 0); idx++)
2827 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, idx)))
2828 saw_frp = true;
2831 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (i))
2832 saw_frp = true;
2835 /* If the port doesn't emit epilogue unwind info, we don't need a
2836 save/restore pair. */
2837 if (!saw_frp)
2838 return;
2840 /* Otherwise, search forward to see if the return insn was the last
2841 basic block of the function. If so, we don't need save/restore. */
2842 gcc_assert (i != NULL);
2843 i = next_real_insn (i);
2844 if (i == NULL)
2845 return;
2847 /* Insert the restore before that next real insn in the stream, and before
2848 a potential NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG -- we do need these notes to be
2849 properly nested. This should be after any label or alignment. This
2850 will be pushed into the CFI stream by the function below. */
2851 while (1)
2853 rtx p = PREV_INSN (i);
2854 if (!NOTE_P (p))
2855 break;
2856 if (NOTE_KIND (p) == NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK)
2857 break;
2858 i = p;
2860 emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE, i);
2862 emit_cfa_remember = true;
2864 /* And emulate the state save. */
2865 gcc_assert (!cfa_remember.in_use);
2866 cfa_remember = cfa;
2867 cfa_remember.in_use = 1;
2870 /* A "subroutine" of dwarf2out_begin_epilogue. Emit the restore required. */
2872 void
2873 dwarf2out_frame_debug_restore_state (void)
2875 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
2876 const char *label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2878 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_restore_state;
2879 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2881 gcc_assert (cfa_remember.in_use);
2882 cfa = cfa_remember;
2883 cfa_remember.in_use = 0;
2886 #endif
2888 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
2889 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
2890 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2892 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2893 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2895 switch (cfi)
2897 case DW_CFA_nop:
2898 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2899 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
2900 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
2901 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2903 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2904 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2905 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2906 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2907 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2908 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
2910 case DW_CFA_offset:
2911 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2912 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2913 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2914 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2915 case DW_CFA_restore:
2916 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2917 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2918 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2919 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2920 case DW_CFA_register:
2921 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2923 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2924 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2925 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2926 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2928 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2929 case DW_CFA_expression:
2930 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
2932 default:
2933 gcc_unreachable ();
2937 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
2938 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
2939 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2941 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2942 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2944 switch (cfi)
2946 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2947 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2948 case DW_CFA_offset:
2949 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2950 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2951 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2953 case DW_CFA_register:
2954 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2956 default:
2957 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2961 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2963 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
2964 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
2965 for collect2 the first time around. */
2967 static void
2968 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back)
2970 tree label;
2972 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2973 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
2975 int flags;
2977 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2979 int fde_encoding;
2980 int per_encoding;
2981 int lsda_encoding;
2983 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2984 /*global=*/0);
2985 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2986 /*global=*/1);
2987 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2988 /*global=*/0);
2989 flags = ((! flag_pic
2990 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2991 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2992 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2993 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2994 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2995 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2996 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2998 else
2999 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
3000 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
3002 #endif
3004 if (eh_frame_section)
3005 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
3006 else
3008 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
3009 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
3010 switch_to_section (data_section);
3012 if (!back)
3014 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
3015 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3016 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
3017 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3018 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3023 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
3024 FOR_EH. */
3026 static void
3027 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
3029 if (for_eh)
3030 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
3031 else
3033 if (!debug_frame_section)
3034 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
3035 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
3036 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
3040 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
3042 static void
3043 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
3045 unsigned long r;
3046 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
3048 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
3049 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
3050 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
3051 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
3052 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
3053 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset));
3054 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
3056 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3057 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3058 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
3059 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3060 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3062 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
3064 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3065 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3066 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
3068 else
3070 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
3071 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
3073 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3075 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3076 if (for_eh)
3077 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
3078 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
3079 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
3080 false, NULL);
3081 else
3082 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3083 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
3084 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3085 break;
3087 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3088 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3089 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3090 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3091 break;
3093 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3094 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3095 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3096 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3097 break;
3099 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3100 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3101 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3102 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3103 break;
3105 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3106 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3107 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3108 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3109 break;
3111 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3112 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3113 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3114 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3115 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3116 break;
3118 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3119 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3120 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3121 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3122 break;
3124 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3125 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3126 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3127 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3128 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3129 break;
3131 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3132 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3133 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3134 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3135 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3136 break;
3138 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3139 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3140 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3141 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3142 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3143 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3144 break;
3146 case DW_CFA_register:
3147 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3148 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3149 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3150 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3151 break;
3153 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3154 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3155 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3156 break;
3158 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3159 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3160 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3161 break;
3163 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3164 break;
3166 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3167 case DW_CFA_expression:
3168 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
3169 break;
3171 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3172 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
3173 gcc_unreachable ();
3175 default:
3176 break;
3181 /* Similar, but do it via assembler directives instead. */
3183 static void
3184 output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3186 unsigned long r, r2;
3188 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3190 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3191 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3192 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3193 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3194 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3195 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3196 /* Should only be created by add_fde_cfi in a code path not
3197 followed when emitting via directives. The assembler is
3198 going to take care of this for us. */
3199 gcc_unreachable ();
3201 case DW_CFA_offset:
3202 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3203 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3204 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3205 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_offset %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3206 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3207 break;
3209 case DW_CFA_restore:
3210 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3211 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3212 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore %lu\n", r);
3213 break;
3215 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3216 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3217 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_undefined %lu\n", r);
3218 break;
3220 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3221 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3222 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_same_value %lu\n", r);
3223 break;
3225 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3226 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3227 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3228 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3229 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3230 break;
3232 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3233 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3234 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_register %lu\n", r);
3235 break;
3237 case DW_CFA_register:
3238 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3239 r2 = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3240 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_register %lu, %lu\n", r, r2);
3241 break;
3243 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3244 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3245 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_offset "
3246 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3247 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3248 break;
3250 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3251 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_remember_state\n");
3252 break;
3253 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
3254 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore_state\n");
3255 break;
3257 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3258 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape 0x%x,", DW_CFA_GNU_args_size);
3259 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3260 if (flag_debug_asm)
3261 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s args_size "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
3262 ASM_COMMENT_START, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3263 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3264 break;
3266 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3267 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_window_save\n");
3268 break;
3270 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3271 case DW_CFA_expression:
3272 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape 0x%x,", cfi->dw_cfi_opc);
3273 output_cfa_loc_raw (cfi);
3274 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3275 break;
3277 default:
3278 gcc_unreachable ();
3282 DEF_VEC_P (dw_cfi_ref);
3283 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (dw_cfi_ref, heap);
3285 /* Output CFIs to bring current FDE to the same state as after executing
3286 CFIs in CFI chain. DO_CFI_ASM is true if .cfi_* directives shall
3287 be emitted, false otherwise. If it is false, FDE and FOR_EH are the
3288 other arguments to pass to output_cfi. */
3290 static void
3291 output_cfis (dw_cfi_ref cfi, bool do_cfi_asm, dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh)
3293 struct dw_cfi_struct cfi_buf;
3294 dw_cfi_ref cfi2;
3295 dw_cfi_ref cfi_args_size = NULL, cfi_cfa = NULL, cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3296 VEC (dw_cfi_ref, heap) *regs = VEC_alloc (dw_cfi_ref, heap, 32);
3297 unsigned int len, idx;
3299 for (;; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3300 switch (cfi ? cfi->dw_cfi_opc : DW_CFA_nop)
3302 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3303 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3304 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3305 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3306 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3307 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3308 /* All advances should be ignored. */
3309 break;
3310 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3312 dw_cfi_ref args_size = cfi_args_size;
3314 /* Skip everything between .cfi_remember_state and
3315 .cfi_restore_state. */
3316 for (cfi2 = cfi->dw_cfi_next; cfi2; cfi2 = cfi2->dw_cfi_next)
3317 if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore_state)
3318 break;
3319 else if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_GNU_args_size)
3320 args_size = cfi2;
3321 else
3322 gcc_assert (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_remember_state);
3324 if (cfi2 == NULL)
3325 goto flush_all;
3326 else
3328 cfi = cfi2;
3329 cfi_args_size = args_size;
3331 break;
3333 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3334 cfi_args_size = cfi;
3335 break;
3336 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3337 goto flush_all;
3338 case DW_CFA_offset:
3339 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3340 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3341 case DW_CFA_restore:
3342 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3343 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3344 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3345 case DW_CFA_register:
3346 case DW_CFA_val_offset:
3347 case DW_CFA_val_offset_sf:
3348 case DW_CFA_expression:
3349 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
3350 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3351 if (VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs) <= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num)
3352 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs,
3353 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num + 1);
3354 VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, cfi);
3355 break;
3356 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3357 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3358 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3359 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3360 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3361 break;
3362 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3363 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3364 break;
3365 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3366 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3367 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3368 break;
3369 case DW_CFA_nop:
3370 gcc_assert (cfi == NULL);
3371 flush_all:
3372 len = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs);
3373 for (idx = 0; idx < len; idx++)
3375 cfi2 = VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, idx, NULL);
3376 if (cfi2 != NULL
3377 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore
3378 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore_extended)
3380 if (do_cfi_asm)
3381 output_cfi_directive (cfi2);
3382 else
3383 output_cfi (cfi2, fde, for_eh);
3386 if (cfi_cfa && cfi_cfa_offset && cfi_cfa_offset != cfi_cfa)
3388 gcc_assert (cfi_cfa->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression);
3389 cfi_buf = *cfi_cfa;
3390 switch (cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc)
3392 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3393 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
3394 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3395 break;
3396 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3397 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
3398 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3399 break;
3400 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3401 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3402 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc;
3403 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd2;
3404 break;
3405 default:
3406 gcc_unreachable ();
3408 cfi_cfa = &cfi_buf;
3410 else if (cfi_cfa_offset)
3411 cfi_cfa = cfi_cfa_offset;
3412 if (cfi_cfa)
3414 if (do_cfi_asm)
3415 output_cfi_directive (cfi_cfa);
3416 else
3417 output_cfi (cfi_cfa, fde, for_eh);
3419 cfi_cfa = NULL;
3420 cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3421 if (cfi_args_size
3422 && cfi_args_size->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset)
3424 if (do_cfi_asm)
3425 output_cfi_directive (cfi_args_size);
3426 else
3427 output_cfi (cfi_args_size, fde, for_eh);
3429 cfi_args_size = NULL;
3430 if (cfi == NULL)
3432 VEC_free (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs);
3433 return;
3435 else if (do_cfi_asm)
3436 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
3437 else
3438 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3439 break;
3440 default:
3441 gcc_unreachable ();
3445 /* Output one FDE. */
3447 static void
3448 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
3449 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
3450 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
3452 const char *begin, *end;
3453 static unsigned int j;
3454 char l1[20], l2[20];
3455 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3457 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
3458 /* empty */ 0);
3459 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
3460 for_eh + j);
3461 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3462 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3463 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3464 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
3465 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3466 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3467 "FDE Length");
3468 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3470 if (for_eh)
3471 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
3472 else
3473 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
3474 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
3476 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3478 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3479 end = fde->dw_fde_end;
3481 else
3483 /* For the first section, prefer dw_fde_begin over
3484 dw_fde_{hot,cold}_section_label, as the latter
3485 might be separated from the real start of the
3486 function by alignment padding. */
3487 if (!second)
3488 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3489 else if (fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3490 begin = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label;
3491 else
3492 begin = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
3493 if (second ^ fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3494 end = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
3495 else
3496 end = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
3499 if (for_eh)
3501 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
3502 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3503 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
3504 "FDE initial location");
3505 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
3506 end, begin, "FDE address range");
3508 else
3510 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
3511 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
3514 if (augmentation[0])
3516 if (any_lsda_needed)
3518 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
3520 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3522 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3523 + 4 /* CIE offset */
3524 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
3525 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
3526 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3528 size += pad;
3529 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
3532 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
3534 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3536 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3537 fde->funcdef_number);
3538 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
3539 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
3540 false,
3541 "Language Specific Data Area");
3543 else
3545 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3546 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3547 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
3548 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
3551 else
3552 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
3555 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
3556 this FDE. */
3557 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
3558 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3559 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3560 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3561 else if (!second)
3563 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3564 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3566 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3567 if (cfi == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3568 break;
3571 else
3573 dw_cfi_ref cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
3575 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3577 cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next;
3578 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
3579 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, false, fde, for_eh);
3580 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = cfi_next;
3582 for (cfi = cfi_next; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3583 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3586 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
3587 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
3588 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
3589 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
3590 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
3592 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
3593 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
3594 switch *back* into the table section. */
3595 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
3596 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
3597 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
3598 #endif
3600 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
3601 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3602 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
3603 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3605 j += 2;
3608 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
3609 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
3610 location of saved registers. */
3612 static void
3613 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
3615 unsigned int i;
3616 dw_fde_ref fde;
3617 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3618 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
3619 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
3620 char augmentation[6];
3621 int augmentation_size;
3622 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3623 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3624 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3625 int return_reg;
3626 rtx personality = NULL;
3627 int dw_cie_version;
3629 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
3630 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
3631 return;
3633 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
3634 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
3635 return;
3637 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
3638 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
3639 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
3640 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
3641 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
3642 specialization doesn't. */
3643 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3644 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
3645 && flag_exceptions
3646 && for_eh)
3647 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3648 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
3649 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
3650 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
3651 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
3652 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
3654 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
3655 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
3656 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
3657 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
3658 if (for_eh)
3660 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
3662 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3663 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
3664 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
3665 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
3666 any_eh_needed = true;
3667 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
3668 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
3669 any_eh_needed = true;
3671 if (! any_eh_needed)
3672 return;
3675 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
3676 if (flag_debug_asm)
3677 app_enable ();
3679 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
3680 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
3682 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
3683 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
3685 /* Output the CIE. */
3686 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
3687 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
3688 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3689 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
3690 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3691 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3692 "Length of Common Information Entry");
3693 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3695 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
3696 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
3697 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
3698 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
3699 "CIE Identifier Tag");
3701 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
3702 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
3703 due to overflowing the return register column. */
3704 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
3705 dw_cie_version = 1;
3706 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
3707 dw_cie_version = 3;
3708 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
3710 augmentation[0] = 0;
3711 augmentation_size = 0;
3713 personality = current_unit_personality;
3714 if (for_eh)
3716 char *p;
3718 /* Augmentation:
3719 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
3720 augmentation section.
3721 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
3722 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
3723 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
3724 FDE code pointers.
3725 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
3726 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
3728 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
3729 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3730 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3732 p = augmentation + 1;
3733 if (personality)
3735 *p++ = 'P';
3736 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
3737 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
3739 if (any_lsda_needed)
3741 *p++ = 'L';
3742 augmentation_size += 1;
3744 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3746 *p++ = 'R';
3747 augmentation_size += 1;
3749 if (p > augmentation + 1)
3751 augmentation[0] = 'z';
3752 *p = '\0';
3755 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
3756 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3758 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3759 + 4 /* CIE Id */
3760 + 1 /* CIE version */
3761 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
3762 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
3763 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
3764 + 1 /* RA column */
3765 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
3766 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
3767 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3769 augmentation_size += pad;
3771 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
3772 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
3773 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
3777 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
3778 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
3779 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
3780 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
3782 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
3783 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3784 else
3785 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3787 if (augmentation[0])
3789 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
3790 if (personality)
3792 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
3793 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
3794 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
3795 personality,
3796 true, NULL);
3799 if (any_lsda_needed)
3800 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
3801 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
3803 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3804 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
3805 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
3808 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3809 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
3811 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
3812 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3813 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
3814 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3816 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
3817 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3819 unsigned int k;
3820 fde = &fde_table[i];
3822 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
3823 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
3824 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
3825 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
3826 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3827 continue;
3829 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections ? 2 : 1); k++)
3830 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
3831 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
3834 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
3835 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
3836 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3837 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
3838 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
3839 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
3840 #endif
3842 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
3843 if (flag_debug_asm)
3844 app_disable ();
3847 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
3849 static void
3850 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
3852 int enc;
3853 rtx ref;
3854 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
3856 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
3858 if (personality)
3860 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3861 ref = personality;
3863 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
3864 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
3865 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
3866 of the weirder relocation types. */
3867 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3868 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3870 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality 0x%x,", enc);
3871 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3872 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3875 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
3877 char lab[20];
3879 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3880 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3881 current_function_funcdef_no);
3882 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
3883 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3885 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3886 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3888 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda 0x%x,", enc);
3889 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3890 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3894 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
3895 the prologue. */
3897 void
3898 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3899 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3901 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3902 char * dup_label;
3903 dw_fde_ref fde;
3904 section *fnsec;
3906 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
3908 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
3909 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
3910 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
3911 be used. */
3912 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
3913 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3914 return;
3915 #else
3916 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3917 return;
3918 #endif
3920 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
3921 switch_to_section (fnsec);
3922 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3923 current_function_funcdef_no);
3924 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3925 current_function_funcdef_no);
3926 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
3927 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
3929 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
3930 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
3931 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3932 return;
3933 #endif
3935 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
3936 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
3938 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
3939 fde_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_fde_node, fde_table, fde_table_allocated);
3940 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
3941 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
3944 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
3945 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
3947 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
3948 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
3949 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
3950 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
3951 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
3952 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
3953 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
3954 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
3955 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
3956 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 0;
3957 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = 0;
3958 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
3959 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
3960 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = NULL;
3961 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
3962 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
3963 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
3964 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
3965 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
3966 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
3967 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
3969 section *unlikelysec;
3970 if (first_function_block_is_cold)
3971 fde->in_std_section = 1;
3972 else
3973 fde->in_std_section
3974 = (fnsec == text_section
3975 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
3976 unlikelysec = unlikely_text_section ();
3977 fde->cold_in_std_section
3978 = (unlikelysec == text_section
3979 || (cold_text_section && unlikelysec == cold_text_section));
3981 else
3983 fde->in_std_section
3984 = (fnsec == text_section
3985 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
3986 fde->cold_in_std_section = 0;
3989 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
3991 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
3992 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
3993 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3994 if (file)
3995 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
3996 #endif
3998 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
3999 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
4000 else
4002 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
4003 if (!current_unit_personality)
4004 current_unit_personality = personality;
4006 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
4007 asm at the point where we emit the CFI data there is no current
4008 function anymore. */
4009 if (personality
4010 && current_unit_personality != personality)
4011 sorry ("Multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
4012 "supporting .cfi.personality directive.");
4016 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
4017 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
4018 been generated. */
4020 void
4021 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4022 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4024 dw_fde_ref fde;
4025 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4027 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4028 last_var_location_insn = NULL_RTX;
4029 #endif
4031 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4032 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4034 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4035 function. */
4036 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
4037 current_function_funcdef_no);
4038 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
4039 fde = current_fde ();
4040 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
4041 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
4044 void
4045 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
4047 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
4048 fde_table = GGC_CNEWVEC (dw_fde_node, FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
4049 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
4050 fde_table_in_use = 0;
4052 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
4053 sake of lookup_cfa. */
4055 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
4056 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
4058 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
4059 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
4060 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
4061 #endif
4064 void
4065 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
4067 /* Output call frame information. */
4068 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
4069 output_call_frame_info (0);
4071 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
4072 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
4073 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
4074 output_call_frame_info (1);
4075 #endif
4078 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
4080 static void
4081 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
4083 section *sec = current_function_section ();
4084 if (sec == text_section)
4085 text_section_used = true;
4086 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
4087 cold_text_section_used = true;
4090 void
4091 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
4093 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
4095 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && !fde->dw_fde_switched_sections);
4097 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 1;
4098 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = !in_cold_section_p;
4100 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
4101 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
4102 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
4103 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
4104 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
4106 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
4107 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
4108 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
4110 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
4111 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
4112 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
4114 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4115 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4117 /* Now do the real section switch. */
4118 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
4120 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4122 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
4123 /* As this is a different FDE, insert all current CFI instructions
4124 again. */
4125 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, true, fde, true);
4127 else
4129 dw_cfi_ref cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4131 cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4132 if (cfi)
4133 while (cfi->dw_cfi_next != NULL)
4134 cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next;
4135 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = cfi;
4138 #endif
4140 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
4141 for emitting location expressions. */
4143 /* Data about a single source file. */
4144 struct GTY(()) dwarf_file_data {
4145 const char * filename;
4146 int emitted_number;
4149 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
4150 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
4151 typedef const struct die_struct *const_dw_die_ref;
4152 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
4153 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
4155 typedef struct GTY(()) deferred_locations_struct
4157 tree variable;
4158 dw_die_ref die;
4159 } deferred_locations;
4161 DEF_VEC_O(deferred_locations);
4162 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(deferred_locations,gc);
4164 static GTY(()) VEC(deferred_locations, gc) *deferred_locations_list;
4166 DEF_VEC_P(dw_die_ref);
4167 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_die_ref,heap);
4169 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
4170 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
4171 implementation are listed below. */
4173 enum dw_val_class
4175 dw_val_class_addr,
4176 dw_val_class_offset,
4177 dw_val_class_loc,
4178 dw_val_class_loc_list,
4179 dw_val_class_range_list,
4180 dw_val_class_const,
4181 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
4182 dw_val_class_const_double,
4183 dw_val_class_vec,
4184 dw_val_class_flag,
4185 dw_val_class_die_ref,
4186 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
4187 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
4188 dw_val_class_lineptr,
4189 dw_val_class_str,
4190 dw_val_class_macptr,
4191 dw_val_class_file,
4192 dw_val_class_data8
4195 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
4197 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_vec_struct {
4198 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
4199 unsigned length;
4200 unsigned elt_size;
4202 dw_vec_const;
4204 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
4205 represented internally. */
4207 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_val_struct {
4208 enum dw_val_class val_class;
4209 union dw_val_struct_union
4211 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
4212 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
4213 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
4214 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
4215 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
4216 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
4217 double_int GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_const_double"))) val_double;
4218 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
4219 struct dw_val_die_union
4221 dw_die_ref die;
4222 int external;
4223 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
4224 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
4225 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
4226 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
4227 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
4228 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
4229 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_data8"))) val_data8[8];
4231 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
4233 dw_val_node;
4235 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
4236 operations. */
4238 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_descr_struct {
4239 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
4240 ENUM_BITFIELD (dwarf_location_atom) dw_loc_opc : 8;
4241 /* Used to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol relocation
4242 from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
4243 unsigned int dtprel : 1;
4244 int dw_loc_addr;
4245 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
4246 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
4248 dw_loc_descr_node;
4250 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
4251 so you can track variables that are in different places over
4252 their entire life. */
4253 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
4254 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
4255 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
4256 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
4257 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
4258 Only on head of list */
4259 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
4260 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
4261 } dw_loc_list_node;
4263 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
4265 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4267 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
4269 static const char *
4270 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
4272 switch (op)
4274 case DW_OP_addr:
4275 return "DW_OP_addr";
4276 case DW_OP_deref:
4277 return "DW_OP_deref";
4278 case DW_OP_const1u:
4279 return "DW_OP_const1u";
4280 case DW_OP_const1s:
4281 return "DW_OP_const1s";
4282 case DW_OP_const2u:
4283 return "DW_OP_const2u";
4284 case DW_OP_const2s:
4285 return "DW_OP_const2s";
4286 case DW_OP_const4u:
4287 return "DW_OP_const4u";
4288 case DW_OP_const4s:
4289 return "DW_OP_const4s";
4290 case DW_OP_const8u:
4291 return "DW_OP_const8u";
4292 case DW_OP_const8s:
4293 return "DW_OP_const8s";
4294 case DW_OP_constu:
4295 return "DW_OP_constu";
4296 case DW_OP_consts:
4297 return "DW_OP_consts";
4298 case DW_OP_dup:
4299 return "DW_OP_dup";
4300 case DW_OP_drop:
4301 return "DW_OP_drop";
4302 case DW_OP_over:
4303 return "DW_OP_over";
4304 case DW_OP_pick:
4305 return "DW_OP_pick";
4306 case DW_OP_swap:
4307 return "DW_OP_swap";
4308 case DW_OP_rot:
4309 return "DW_OP_rot";
4310 case DW_OP_xderef:
4311 return "DW_OP_xderef";
4312 case DW_OP_abs:
4313 return "DW_OP_abs";
4314 case DW_OP_and:
4315 return "DW_OP_and";
4316 case DW_OP_div:
4317 return "DW_OP_div";
4318 case DW_OP_minus:
4319 return "DW_OP_minus";
4320 case DW_OP_mod:
4321 return "DW_OP_mod";
4322 case DW_OP_mul:
4323 return "DW_OP_mul";
4324 case DW_OP_neg:
4325 return "DW_OP_neg";
4326 case DW_OP_not:
4327 return "DW_OP_not";
4328 case DW_OP_or:
4329 return "DW_OP_or";
4330 case DW_OP_plus:
4331 return "DW_OP_plus";
4332 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4333 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
4334 case DW_OP_shl:
4335 return "DW_OP_shl";
4336 case DW_OP_shr:
4337 return "DW_OP_shr";
4338 case DW_OP_shra:
4339 return "DW_OP_shra";
4340 case DW_OP_xor:
4341 return "DW_OP_xor";
4342 case DW_OP_bra:
4343 return "DW_OP_bra";
4344 case DW_OP_eq:
4345 return "DW_OP_eq";
4346 case DW_OP_ge:
4347 return "DW_OP_ge";
4348 case DW_OP_gt:
4349 return "DW_OP_gt";
4350 case DW_OP_le:
4351 return "DW_OP_le";
4352 case DW_OP_lt:
4353 return "DW_OP_lt";
4354 case DW_OP_ne:
4355 return "DW_OP_ne";
4356 case DW_OP_skip:
4357 return "DW_OP_skip";
4358 case DW_OP_lit0:
4359 return "DW_OP_lit0";
4360 case DW_OP_lit1:
4361 return "DW_OP_lit1";
4362 case DW_OP_lit2:
4363 return "DW_OP_lit2";
4364 case DW_OP_lit3:
4365 return "DW_OP_lit3";
4366 case DW_OP_lit4:
4367 return "DW_OP_lit4";
4368 case DW_OP_lit5:
4369 return "DW_OP_lit5";
4370 case DW_OP_lit6:
4371 return "DW_OP_lit6";
4372 case DW_OP_lit7:
4373 return "DW_OP_lit7";
4374 case DW_OP_lit8:
4375 return "DW_OP_lit8";
4376 case DW_OP_lit9:
4377 return "DW_OP_lit9";
4378 case DW_OP_lit10:
4379 return "DW_OP_lit10";
4380 case DW_OP_lit11:
4381 return "DW_OP_lit11";
4382 case DW_OP_lit12:
4383 return "DW_OP_lit12";
4384 case DW_OP_lit13:
4385 return "DW_OP_lit13";
4386 case DW_OP_lit14:
4387 return "DW_OP_lit14";
4388 case DW_OP_lit15:
4389 return "DW_OP_lit15";
4390 case DW_OP_lit16:
4391 return "DW_OP_lit16";
4392 case DW_OP_lit17:
4393 return "DW_OP_lit17";
4394 case DW_OP_lit18:
4395 return "DW_OP_lit18";
4396 case DW_OP_lit19:
4397 return "DW_OP_lit19";
4398 case DW_OP_lit20:
4399 return "DW_OP_lit20";
4400 case DW_OP_lit21:
4401 return "DW_OP_lit21";
4402 case DW_OP_lit22:
4403 return "DW_OP_lit22";
4404 case DW_OP_lit23:
4405 return "DW_OP_lit23";
4406 case DW_OP_lit24:
4407 return "DW_OP_lit24";
4408 case DW_OP_lit25:
4409 return "DW_OP_lit25";
4410 case DW_OP_lit26:
4411 return "DW_OP_lit26";
4412 case DW_OP_lit27:
4413 return "DW_OP_lit27";
4414 case DW_OP_lit28:
4415 return "DW_OP_lit28";
4416 case DW_OP_lit29:
4417 return "DW_OP_lit29";
4418 case DW_OP_lit30:
4419 return "DW_OP_lit30";
4420 case DW_OP_lit31:
4421 return "DW_OP_lit31";
4422 case DW_OP_reg0:
4423 return "DW_OP_reg0";
4424 case DW_OP_reg1:
4425 return "DW_OP_reg1";
4426 case DW_OP_reg2:
4427 return "DW_OP_reg2";
4428 case DW_OP_reg3:
4429 return "DW_OP_reg3";
4430 case DW_OP_reg4:
4431 return "DW_OP_reg4";
4432 case DW_OP_reg5:
4433 return "DW_OP_reg5";
4434 case DW_OP_reg6:
4435 return "DW_OP_reg6";
4436 case DW_OP_reg7:
4437 return "DW_OP_reg7";
4438 case DW_OP_reg8:
4439 return "DW_OP_reg8";
4440 case DW_OP_reg9:
4441 return "DW_OP_reg9";
4442 case DW_OP_reg10:
4443 return "DW_OP_reg10";
4444 case DW_OP_reg11:
4445 return "DW_OP_reg11";
4446 case DW_OP_reg12:
4447 return "DW_OP_reg12";
4448 case DW_OP_reg13:
4449 return "DW_OP_reg13";
4450 case DW_OP_reg14:
4451 return "DW_OP_reg14";
4452 case DW_OP_reg15:
4453 return "DW_OP_reg15";
4454 case DW_OP_reg16:
4455 return "DW_OP_reg16";
4456 case DW_OP_reg17:
4457 return "DW_OP_reg17";
4458 case DW_OP_reg18:
4459 return "DW_OP_reg18";
4460 case DW_OP_reg19:
4461 return "DW_OP_reg19";
4462 case DW_OP_reg20:
4463 return "DW_OP_reg20";
4464 case DW_OP_reg21:
4465 return "DW_OP_reg21";
4466 case DW_OP_reg22:
4467 return "DW_OP_reg22";
4468 case DW_OP_reg23:
4469 return "DW_OP_reg23";
4470 case DW_OP_reg24:
4471 return "DW_OP_reg24";
4472 case DW_OP_reg25:
4473 return "DW_OP_reg25";
4474 case DW_OP_reg26:
4475 return "DW_OP_reg26";
4476 case DW_OP_reg27:
4477 return "DW_OP_reg27";
4478 case DW_OP_reg28:
4479 return "DW_OP_reg28";
4480 case DW_OP_reg29:
4481 return "DW_OP_reg29";
4482 case DW_OP_reg30:
4483 return "DW_OP_reg30";
4484 case DW_OP_reg31:
4485 return "DW_OP_reg31";
4486 case DW_OP_breg0:
4487 return "DW_OP_breg0";
4488 case DW_OP_breg1:
4489 return "DW_OP_breg1";
4490 case DW_OP_breg2:
4491 return "DW_OP_breg2";
4492 case DW_OP_breg3:
4493 return "DW_OP_breg3";
4494 case DW_OP_breg4:
4495 return "DW_OP_breg4";
4496 case DW_OP_breg5:
4497 return "DW_OP_breg5";
4498 case DW_OP_breg6:
4499 return "DW_OP_breg6";
4500 case DW_OP_breg7:
4501 return "DW_OP_breg7";
4502 case DW_OP_breg8:
4503 return "DW_OP_breg8";
4504 case DW_OP_breg9:
4505 return "DW_OP_breg9";
4506 case DW_OP_breg10:
4507 return "DW_OP_breg10";
4508 case DW_OP_breg11:
4509 return "DW_OP_breg11";
4510 case DW_OP_breg12:
4511 return "DW_OP_breg12";
4512 case DW_OP_breg13:
4513 return "DW_OP_breg13";
4514 case DW_OP_breg14:
4515 return "DW_OP_breg14";
4516 case DW_OP_breg15:
4517 return "DW_OP_breg15";
4518 case DW_OP_breg16:
4519 return "DW_OP_breg16";
4520 case DW_OP_breg17:
4521 return "DW_OP_breg17";
4522 case DW_OP_breg18:
4523 return "DW_OP_breg18";
4524 case DW_OP_breg19:
4525 return "DW_OP_breg19";
4526 case DW_OP_breg20:
4527 return "DW_OP_breg20";
4528 case DW_OP_breg21:
4529 return "DW_OP_breg21";
4530 case DW_OP_breg22:
4531 return "DW_OP_breg22";
4532 case DW_OP_breg23:
4533 return "DW_OP_breg23";
4534 case DW_OP_breg24:
4535 return "DW_OP_breg24";
4536 case DW_OP_breg25:
4537 return "DW_OP_breg25";
4538 case DW_OP_breg26:
4539 return "DW_OP_breg26";
4540 case DW_OP_breg27:
4541 return "DW_OP_breg27";
4542 case DW_OP_breg28:
4543 return "DW_OP_breg28";
4544 case DW_OP_breg29:
4545 return "DW_OP_breg29";
4546 case DW_OP_breg30:
4547 return "DW_OP_breg30";
4548 case DW_OP_breg31:
4549 return "DW_OP_breg31";
4550 case DW_OP_regx:
4551 return "DW_OP_regx";
4552 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4553 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
4554 case DW_OP_bregx:
4555 return "DW_OP_bregx";
4556 case DW_OP_piece:
4557 return "DW_OP_piece";
4558 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4559 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
4560 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4561 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
4562 case DW_OP_nop:
4563 return "DW_OP_nop";
4565 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
4566 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
4567 case DW_OP_call2:
4568 return "DW_OP_call2";
4569 case DW_OP_call4:
4570 return "DW_OP_call4";
4571 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4572 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
4573 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4574 return "DW_OP_implicit_value";
4575 case DW_OP_stack_value:
4576 return "DW_OP_stack_value";
4577 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
4578 return "DW_OP_form_tls_address";
4579 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
4580 return "DW_OP_call_frame_cfa";
4581 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
4582 return "DW_OP_bit_piece";
4584 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
4585 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
4586 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
4587 return "DW_OP_GNU_uninit";
4588 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
4589 return "DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr";
4591 default:
4592 return "OP_<unknown>";
4596 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
4597 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
4598 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
4600 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4601 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
4602 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
4604 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_descr_node);
4606 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
4607 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4608 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
4609 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4610 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
4612 return descr;
4615 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
4616 REG and OFFSET. */
4618 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4619 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4621 if (reg <= 31)
4622 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
4623 offset, 0);
4624 else
4625 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
4628 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
4630 static inline void
4631 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4633 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
4635 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4636 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
4639 *d = descr;
4642 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
4644 static void
4645 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4647 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4648 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
4650 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
4652 if (!offset)
4653 return;
4655 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4656 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
4659 p = NULL;
4660 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
4661 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
4662 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
4663 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
4664 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
4666 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
4667 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
4668 if (p != NULL
4669 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
4670 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
4671 *p += offset;
4673 else if (offset > 0)
4674 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
4676 else
4678 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (offset);
4679 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
4683 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4684 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
4686 static void
4687 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4689 dw_loc_list_ref d;
4690 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
4691 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
4693 #endif
4695 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
4697 static unsigned long
4698 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4700 unsigned long size = 1;
4702 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4704 case DW_OP_addr:
4705 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4706 break;
4707 case DW_OP_const1u:
4708 case DW_OP_const1s:
4709 size += 1;
4710 break;
4711 case DW_OP_const2u:
4712 case DW_OP_const2s:
4713 size += 2;
4714 break;
4715 case DW_OP_const4u:
4716 case DW_OP_const4s:
4717 size += 4;
4718 break;
4719 case DW_OP_const8u:
4720 case DW_OP_const8s:
4721 size += 8;
4722 break;
4723 case DW_OP_constu:
4724 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4725 break;
4726 case DW_OP_consts:
4727 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4728 break;
4729 case DW_OP_pick:
4730 size += 1;
4731 break;
4732 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4733 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4734 break;
4735 case DW_OP_skip:
4736 case DW_OP_bra:
4737 size += 2;
4738 break;
4739 case DW_OP_breg0:
4740 case DW_OP_breg1:
4741 case DW_OP_breg2:
4742 case DW_OP_breg3:
4743 case DW_OP_breg4:
4744 case DW_OP_breg5:
4745 case DW_OP_breg6:
4746 case DW_OP_breg7:
4747 case DW_OP_breg8:
4748 case DW_OP_breg9:
4749 case DW_OP_breg10:
4750 case DW_OP_breg11:
4751 case DW_OP_breg12:
4752 case DW_OP_breg13:
4753 case DW_OP_breg14:
4754 case DW_OP_breg15:
4755 case DW_OP_breg16:
4756 case DW_OP_breg17:
4757 case DW_OP_breg18:
4758 case DW_OP_breg19:
4759 case DW_OP_breg20:
4760 case DW_OP_breg21:
4761 case DW_OP_breg22:
4762 case DW_OP_breg23:
4763 case DW_OP_breg24:
4764 case DW_OP_breg25:
4765 case DW_OP_breg26:
4766 case DW_OP_breg27:
4767 case DW_OP_breg28:
4768 case DW_OP_breg29:
4769 case DW_OP_breg30:
4770 case DW_OP_breg31:
4771 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4772 break;
4773 case DW_OP_regx:
4774 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4775 break;
4776 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4777 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4778 break;
4779 case DW_OP_bregx:
4780 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4781 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
4782 break;
4783 case DW_OP_piece:
4784 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4785 break;
4786 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4787 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4788 size += 1;
4789 break;
4790 case DW_OP_call2:
4791 size += 2;
4792 break;
4793 case DW_OP_call4:
4794 size += 4;
4795 break;
4796 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4797 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4798 break;
4799 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4800 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
4801 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
4802 break;
4803 default:
4804 break;
4807 return size;
4810 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
4812 static unsigned long
4813 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4815 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
4816 unsigned long size;
4818 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
4819 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
4820 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4822 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
4823 break;
4824 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4826 if (! l)
4827 return size;
4829 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4831 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
4832 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4835 return size;
4838 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4839 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4840 #endif
4842 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
4844 static void
4845 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4847 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
4848 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
4850 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4852 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4853 case DW_OP_const2u:
4854 case DW_OP_const2s:
4855 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4856 break;
4857 case DW_OP_const4u:
4858 case DW_OP_const4s:
4859 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4860 break;
4861 case DW_OP_const8u:
4862 case DW_OP_const8s:
4863 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
4864 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4865 break;
4866 case DW_OP_skip:
4867 case DW_OP_bra:
4869 int offset;
4871 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
4872 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
4874 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
4876 break;
4877 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4878 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4879 switch (val2->val_class)
4881 case dw_val_class_const:
4882 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
4883 break;
4884 case dw_val_class_vec:
4886 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
4887 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
4888 unsigned int i;
4889 unsigned char *p;
4891 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
4893 elt_size /= 2;
4894 len *= 2;
4896 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
4897 i < len;
4898 i++, p += elt_size)
4899 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
4900 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
4902 break;
4903 case dw_val_class_const_double:
4905 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
4907 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4909 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
4910 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
4912 else
4914 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
4915 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
4917 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
4918 first, NULL);
4919 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
4920 second, NULL);
4922 break;
4923 case dw_val_class_addr:
4924 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
4925 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
4926 break;
4927 default:
4928 gcc_unreachable ();
4930 break;
4931 #else
4932 case DW_OP_const2u:
4933 case DW_OP_const2s:
4934 case DW_OP_const4u:
4935 case DW_OP_const4s:
4936 case DW_OP_const8u:
4937 case DW_OP_const8s:
4938 case DW_OP_skip:
4939 case DW_OP_bra:
4940 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4941 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
4942 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
4943 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
4944 only doing unwinding. */
4945 gcc_unreachable ();
4946 #endif
4947 case DW_OP_const1u:
4948 case DW_OP_const1s:
4949 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4950 break;
4951 case DW_OP_constu:
4952 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4953 break;
4954 case DW_OP_consts:
4955 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4956 break;
4957 case DW_OP_pick:
4958 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4959 break;
4960 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4961 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4962 break;
4963 case DW_OP_breg0:
4964 case DW_OP_breg1:
4965 case DW_OP_breg2:
4966 case DW_OP_breg3:
4967 case DW_OP_breg4:
4968 case DW_OP_breg5:
4969 case DW_OP_breg6:
4970 case DW_OP_breg7:
4971 case DW_OP_breg8:
4972 case DW_OP_breg9:
4973 case DW_OP_breg10:
4974 case DW_OP_breg11:
4975 case DW_OP_breg12:
4976 case DW_OP_breg13:
4977 case DW_OP_breg14:
4978 case DW_OP_breg15:
4979 case DW_OP_breg16:
4980 case DW_OP_breg17:
4981 case DW_OP_breg18:
4982 case DW_OP_breg19:
4983 case DW_OP_breg20:
4984 case DW_OP_breg21:
4985 case DW_OP_breg22:
4986 case DW_OP_breg23:
4987 case DW_OP_breg24:
4988 case DW_OP_breg25:
4989 case DW_OP_breg26:
4990 case DW_OP_breg27:
4991 case DW_OP_breg28:
4992 case DW_OP_breg29:
4993 case DW_OP_breg30:
4994 case DW_OP_breg31:
4995 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4996 break;
4997 case DW_OP_regx:
4998 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4999 break;
5000 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5001 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5002 break;
5003 case DW_OP_bregx:
5004 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5005 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5006 break;
5007 case DW_OP_piece:
5008 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5009 break;
5010 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5011 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5012 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5013 break;
5015 case DW_OP_addr:
5016 if (loc->dtprel)
5018 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
5020 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
5021 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
5022 val1->v.val_addr);
5023 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5025 else
5026 gcc_unreachable ();
5028 else
5030 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5031 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
5032 #else
5033 gcc_unreachable ();
5034 #endif
5036 break;
5038 default:
5039 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5040 break;
5044 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
5046 static void
5047 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5049 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5051 /* Output the opcode. */
5052 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
5053 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
5055 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
5056 output_loc_operands (loc);
5060 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
5061 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
5063 static void
5064 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5066 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
5067 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
5069 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
5071 case DW_OP_addr:
5072 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5073 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
5074 gcc_unreachable ();
5076 case DW_OP_const1u:
5077 case DW_OP_const1s:
5078 case DW_OP_pick:
5079 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5080 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5081 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5082 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
5083 break;
5085 case DW_OP_const2u:
5086 case DW_OP_const2s:
5087 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5088 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
5089 break;
5091 case DW_OP_const4u:
5092 case DW_OP_const4s:
5093 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5094 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
5095 break;
5097 case DW_OP_const8u:
5098 case DW_OP_const8s:
5099 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
5100 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5101 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
5102 break;
5104 case DW_OP_skip:
5105 case DW_OP_bra:
5107 int offset;
5109 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
5110 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
5112 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5113 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
5115 break;
5117 case DW_OP_constu:
5118 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5119 case DW_OP_regx:
5120 case DW_OP_piece:
5121 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5122 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5123 break;
5125 case DW_OP_consts:
5126 case DW_OP_breg0:
5127 case DW_OP_breg1:
5128 case DW_OP_breg2:
5129 case DW_OP_breg3:
5130 case DW_OP_breg4:
5131 case DW_OP_breg5:
5132 case DW_OP_breg6:
5133 case DW_OP_breg7:
5134 case DW_OP_breg8:
5135 case DW_OP_breg9:
5136 case DW_OP_breg10:
5137 case DW_OP_breg11:
5138 case DW_OP_breg12:
5139 case DW_OP_breg13:
5140 case DW_OP_breg14:
5141 case DW_OP_breg15:
5142 case DW_OP_breg16:
5143 case DW_OP_breg17:
5144 case DW_OP_breg18:
5145 case DW_OP_breg19:
5146 case DW_OP_breg20:
5147 case DW_OP_breg21:
5148 case DW_OP_breg22:
5149 case DW_OP_breg23:
5150 case DW_OP_breg24:
5151 case DW_OP_breg25:
5152 case DW_OP_breg26:
5153 case DW_OP_breg27:
5154 case DW_OP_breg28:
5155 case DW_OP_breg29:
5156 case DW_OP_breg30:
5157 case DW_OP_breg31:
5158 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5159 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5160 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
5161 break;
5163 case DW_OP_bregx:
5164 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5165 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5166 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5167 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
5168 break;
5170 default:
5171 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5172 break;
5176 static void
5177 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5179 while (1)
5181 /* Output the opcode. */
5182 fprintf (asm_out_file, "0x%x", loc->dw_loc_opc);
5183 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
5185 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
5186 break;
5187 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
5189 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5193 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
5194 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
5196 static void
5197 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5199 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5200 unsigned long size;
5202 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5203 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, NULL);
5205 /* Output the size of the block. */
5206 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5207 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5208 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
5210 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5211 output_loc_sequence (loc);
5214 /* Similar, but used for .cfi_escape. */
5216 static void
5217 output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5219 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5220 unsigned long size;
5222 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5223 fprintf (asm_out_file, "0x%x,", cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num);
5225 /* Output the size of the block. */
5226 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5227 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5228 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (size);
5229 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5231 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5232 output_loc_sequence_raw (loc);
5235 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
5236 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
5237 expression. */
5239 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5240 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5242 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
5244 offset += cfa->offset;
5246 if (cfa->indirect)
5248 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
5249 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
5250 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
5251 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5252 if (offset != 0)
5254 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
5255 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5258 else
5259 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
5261 return head;
5264 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
5265 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
5266 ALIGNMENT byte. */
5268 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5269 build_cfa_aligned_loc (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
5271 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head;
5272 unsigned int dwarf_fp
5273 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
5275 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
5276 if (cfa.reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa.indirect == 0)
5278 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
5279 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
5280 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
5281 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
5283 else
5284 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
5285 return head;
5288 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
5289 descriptor sequence. */
5291 static void
5292 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
5294 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
5295 cfa->offset = 0;
5296 cfa->base_offset = 0;
5297 cfa->indirect = 0;
5298 cfa->reg = -1;
5300 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
5302 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
5304 switch (op)
5306 case DW_OP_reg0:
5307 case DW_OP_reg1:
5308 case DW_OP_reg2:
5309 case DW_OP_reg3:
5310 case DW_OP_reg4:
5311 case DW_OP_reg5:
5312 case DW_OP_reg6:
5313 case DW_OP_reg7:
5314 case DW_OP_reg8:
5315 case DW_OP_reg9:
5316 case DW_OP_reg10:
5317 case DW_OP_reg11:
5318 case DW_OP_reg12:
5319 case DW_OP_reg13:
5320 case DW_OP_reg14:
5321 case DW_OP_reg15:
5322 case DW_OP_reg16:
5323 case DW_OP_reg17:
5324 case DW_OP_reg18:
5325 case DW_OP_reg19:
5326 case DW_OP_reg20:
5327 case DW_OP_reg21:
5328 case DW_OP_reg22:
5329 case DW_OP_reg23:
5330 case DW_OP_reg24:
5331 case DW_OP_reg25:
5332 case DW_OP_reg26:
5333 case DW_OP_reg27:
5334 case DW_OP_reg28:
5335 case DW_OP_reg29:
5336 case DW_OP_reg30:
5337 case DW_OP_reg31:
5338 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
5339 break;
5340 case DW_OP_regx:
5341 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5342 break;
5343 case DW_OP_breg0:
5344 case DW_OP_breg1:
5345 case DW_OP_breg2:
5346 case DW_OP_breg3:
5347 case DW_OP_breg4:
5348 case DW_OP_breg5:
5349 case DW_OP_breg6:
5350 case DW_OP_breg7:
5351 case DW_OP_breg8:
5352 case DW_OP_breg9:
5353 case DW_OP_breg10:
5354 case DW_OP_breg11:
5355 case DW_OP_breg12:
5356 case DW_OP_breg13:
5357 case DW_OP_breg14:
5358 case DW_OP_breg15:
5359 case DW_OP_breg16:
5360 case DW_OP_breg17:
5361 case DW_OP_breg18:
5362 case DW_OP_breg19:
5363 case DW_OP_breg20:
5364 case DW_OP_breg21:
5365 case DW_OP_breg22:
5366 case DW_OP_breg23:
5367 case DW_OP_breg24:
5368 case DW_OP_breg25:
5369 case DW_OP_breg26:
5370 case DW_OP_breg27:
5371 case DW_OP_breg28:
5372 case DW_OP_breg29:
5373 case DW_OP_breg30:
5374 case DW_OP_breg31:
5375 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
5376 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5377 break;
5378 case DW_OP_bregx:
5379 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5380 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
5381 break;
5382 case DW_OP_deref:
5383 cfa->indirect = 1;
5384 break;
5385 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5386 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
5387 break;
5388 default:
5389 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
5390 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
5394 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
5396 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
5397 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5399 /* .debug_str support. */
5400 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
5402 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
5403 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
5404 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
5405 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
5406 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
5407 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
5408 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
5409 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5410 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5411 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
5412 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
5413 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
5414 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
5415 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
5416 dw_die_ref);
5417 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
5418 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
5419 static void dwarf2out_direct_call (tree);
5420 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree, int);
5421 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call (int);
5422 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
5423 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
5425 /* The debug hooks structure. */
5427 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
5429 dwarf2out_init,
5430 dwarf2out_finish,
5431 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
5432 dwarf2out_define,
5433 dwarf2out_undef,
5434 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
5435 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
5436 dwarf2out_begin_block,
5437 dwarf2out_end_block,
5438 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
5439 dwarf2out_source_line,
5440 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
5441 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
5442 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
5443 dwarf2out_begin_function,
5444 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
5445 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
5446 dwarf2out_global_decl,
5447 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
5448 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
5449 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
5450 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
5451 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
5452 something tries to reference them. */
5453 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
5454 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
5455 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
5456 dwarf2out_var_location,
5457 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
5458 dwarf2out_direct_call,
5459 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token,
5460 dwarf2out_virtual_call,
5461 dwarf2out_set_name,
5462 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
5464 #endif
5466 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
5467 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
5468 throughout the remainder of this file. */
5470 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
5471 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
5472 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
5473 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
5475 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
5476 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
5478 typedef long int dw_offset;
5480 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
5482 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
5483 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
5484 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
5485 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
5486 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
5487 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
5488 typedef struct comdat_type_struct *comdat_type_node_ref;
5490 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
5491 line number associated with the label generated for that
5492 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
5493 the line number entry. */
5495 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
5496 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5497 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5499 dw_line_info_entry;
5501 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
5502 own sequence. */
5503 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_separate_line_info_struct {
5504 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5505 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5506 unsigned long function;
5508 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
5510 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
5511 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
5512 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
5514 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
5515 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
5516 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
5518 dw_attr_node;
5520 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
5521 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
5523 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
5524 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
5525 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
5527 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"))) die_struct {
5528 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
5529 union die_symbol_or_type_node
5531 char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
5532 comdat_type_node_ref GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
5534 GTY ((desc ("dwarf_version >= 4"))) die_id;
5535 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
5536 dw_die_ref die_parent;
5537 dw_die_ref die_child;
5538 dw_die_ref die_sib;
5539 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
5540 dw_offset die_offset;
5541 unsigned long die_abbrev;
5542 int die_mark;
5543 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
5544 int die_perennial_p;
5545 unsigned int decl_id;
5547 die_node;
5549 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
5550 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
5551 c = die->die_child; \
5552 if (c) do { \
5553 c = c->die_sib; \
5554 expr; \
5555 } while (c != die->die_child); \
5556 } while (0)
5558 /* The pubname structure */
5560 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
5561 dw_die_ref die;
5562 const char *name;
5564 pubname_entry;
5566 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
5567 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
5569 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_struct {
5570 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
5571 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
5572 int num;
5575 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label_struct {
5576 const char *begin;
5577 const char *end;
5580 /* The comdat type node structure. */
5581 typedef struct GTY(()) comdat_type_struct
5583 dw_die_ref root_die;
5584 dw_die_ref type_die;
5585 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
5586 struct comdat_type_struct *next;
5588 comdat_type_node;
5590 /* The limbo die list structure. */
5591 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
5592 dw_die_ref die;
5593 tree created_for;
5594 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
5596 limbo_die_node;
5598 typedef struct GTY(()) skeleton_chain_struct
5600 dw_die_ref old_die;
5601 dw_die_ref new_die;
5602 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
5604 skeleton_chain_node;
5606 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
5607 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
5608 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
5609 #endif
5611 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
5612 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
5614 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
5615 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
5616 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
5617 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
5618 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
5619 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
5621 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
5622 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
5623 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
5624 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
5625 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
5626 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
5627 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
5628 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
5629 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
5630 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
5632 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
5633 language, and compiler version. */
5635 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
5636 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5637 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
5639 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
5640 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5641 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
5642 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
5644 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
5645 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
5647 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
5648 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
5649 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5650 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5651 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
5653 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
5654 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
5655 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
5656 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5657 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5658 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
5660 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
5661 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
5662 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
5663 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
5664 #else
5665 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
5666 #endif
5667 #endif
5669 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
5670 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
5671 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
5673 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
5674 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
5676 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
5677 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
5679 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
5680 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
5681 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
5682 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
5683 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
5685 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5686 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
5687 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
5688 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
5689 #endif
5691 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
5692 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
5694 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
5695 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
5697 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
5698 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
5700 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
5701 DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are
5702 set. */
5703 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
5705 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
5706 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
5708 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
5709 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
5710 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
5712 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
5713 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
5714 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t common_block_die_table;
5716 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
5717 dw_die_ref die;
5718 tree arg;
5719 } die_arg_entry;
5721 DEF_VEC_O(die_arg_entry);
5722 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(die_arg_entry,gc);
5724 /* Node of the variable location list. */
5725 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
5726 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
5727 const char * GTY (()) label;
5728 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
5729 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
5732 /* Variable location list. */
5733 struct GTY (()) var_loc_list_def {
5734 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
5736 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
5737 it is marked through the chain. */
5738 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
5740 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
5741 unsigned int decl_id;
5743 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
5746 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
5747 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
5749 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
5750 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
5751 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
5752 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
5753 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
5755 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
5756 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
5758 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
5759 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
5761 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5762 abbrev_die_table. */
5763 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
5765 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5766 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
5767 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
5768 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
5770 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
5771 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
5773 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
5774 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
5776 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5777 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
5778 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
5779 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
5781 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
5782 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
5784 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
5785 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
5787 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5788 line_info_table. */
5789 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
5791 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5792 accessible names. */
5793 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
5795 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5796 accessible types. */
5797 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
5799 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
5800 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
5802 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
5803 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
5805 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
5806 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
5808 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5809 arange_table. */
5810 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
5812 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
5813 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
5815 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
5816 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
5818 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
5819 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
5821 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
5822 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
5823 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
5825 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
5826 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
5828 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
5829 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
5831 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5832 ranges_table. */
5833 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
5835 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
5836 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
5838 /* Unique label counter. */
5839 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
5841 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
5842 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
5844 /* The direct call table structure. */
5846 typedef struct GTY(()) dcall_struct {
5847 unsigned int poc_label_num;
5848 tree poc_decl;
5849 dw_die_ref targ_die;
5851 dcall_entry;
5853 DEF_VEC_O(dcall_entry);
5854 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dcall_entry, gc);
5856 /* The virtual call table structure. */
5858 typedef struct GTY(()) vcall_struct {
5859 unsigned int poc_label_num;
5860 unsigned int vtable_slot;
5862 vcall_entry;
5864 DEF_VEC_O(vcall_entry);
5865 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(vcall_entry, gc);
5867 /* Pointers to the direct and virtual call tables. */
5868 static GTY (()) VEC (dcall_entry, gc) * dcall_table = NULL;
5869 static GTY (()) VEC (vcall_entry, gc) * vcall_table = NULL;
5871 /* A hash table to map INSN_UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
5873 struct GTY (()) vcall_insn {
5874 int insn_uid;
5875 unsigned int vtable_slot;
5878 static GTY ((param_is (struct vcall_insn))) htab_t vcall_insn_table;
5880 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5881 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
5882 static int current_function_has_inlines;
5883 #endif
5884 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
5885 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
5886 #endif
5888 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
5889 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
5891 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
5892 static GTY(()) int label_num;
5894 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
5895 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
5897 static GTY(()) VEC(die_arg_entry,gc) *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
5899 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5901 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
5902 within the current function. */
5903 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
5905 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
5907 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
5908 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
5909 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
5910 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
5911 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
5912 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
5913 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
5914 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
5915 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
5916 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
5917 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
5918 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
5919 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
5920 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
5921 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
5922 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
5923 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5924 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
5925 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
5926 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
5927 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
5928 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
5929 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
5930 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5931 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
5932 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
5933 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
5934 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
5935 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
5936 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
5937 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
5938 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
5939 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
5940 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
5941 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5942 dw_loc_list_ref);
5943 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
5944 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
5945 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
5946 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5947 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5948 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5949 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5950 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
5951 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5952 unsigned long);
5953 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
5954 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5955 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
5956 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
5957 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5958 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5959 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5960 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5961 static bool is_c_family (void);
5962 static bool is_cxx (void);
5963 static bool is_java (void);
5964 static bool is_fortran (void);
5965 static bool is_ada (void);
5966 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5967 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
5968 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
5969 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
5970 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
5971 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
5972 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
5973 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
5974 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
5975 static hashval_t common_block_die_table_hash (const void *);
5976 static int common_block_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
5977 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
5978 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
5979 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
5980 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
5981 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
5982 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
5983 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
5984 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
5985 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
5986 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
5987 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
5988 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
5989 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
5990 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
5991 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
5992 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
5993 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_ref,
5994 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
5995 struct checksum_attributes;
5996 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
5997 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
5998 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
5999 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
6000 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
6001 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
6002 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
6003 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
6004 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6005 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
6006 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
6007 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
6008 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
6009 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
6010 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
6011 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
6012 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
6013 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
6014 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
6015 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
6016 static void copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6017 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
6018 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
6019 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
6020 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
6021 dw_die_ref);
6022 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
6023 static dw_die_ref copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6024 static void copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6025 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
6027 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
6028 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
6029 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
6030 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
6031 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
6032 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
6033 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
6034 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
6035 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6036 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
6037 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
6038 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6039 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6040 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
6041 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6042 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
6043 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6044 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6045 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
6046 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
6047 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
6048 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
6049 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
6050 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
6051 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
6052 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
6053 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
6054 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
6055 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6056 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
6057 static void output_aranges (void);
6058 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
6059 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
6060 static unsigned int add_ranges_by_labels (const char *, const char *);
6061 static void output_ranges (void);
6062 static void output_line_info (void);
6063 static void output_file_names (void);
6064 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
6065 static int is_base_type (tree);
6066 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6067 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6068 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6069 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6070 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
6071 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
6072 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
6073 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
6074 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
6075 enum var_init_status);
6076 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6077 enum var_init_status);
6078 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
6079 enum var_init_status);
6080 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
6081 static int resolve_one_addr (rtx *, void *);
6082 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6083 enum var_init_status);
6084 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6085 enum var_init_status);
6086 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6087 enum var_init_status);
6088 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int);
6089 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int);
6090 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
6091 static tree field_type (const_tree);
6092 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6093 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6094 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
6095 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
6096 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6097 dw_loc_list_ref);
6098 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6099 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
6100 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
6101 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
6102 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
6103 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
6104 enum dwarf_attribute);
6105 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6106 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
6107 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
6108 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
6109 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
6110 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
6111 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6112 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6113 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6114 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6115 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6116 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6117 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6118 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6119 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
6120 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
6121 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
6122 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6123 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6124 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6125 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6126 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6127 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
6128 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
6129 #if 0
6130 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
6131 #endif
6132 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6133 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
6134 #if 0
6135 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6136 #endif
6137 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6138 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6139 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
6140 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6141 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6142 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6143 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6144 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6145 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6146 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6147 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6148 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6149 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6150 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
6151 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6152 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6153 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
6154 enum debug_info_usage);
6155 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6156 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6157 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6158 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6159 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6160 static int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
6161 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
6162 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6163 static void gen_decl_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6164 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
6165 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
6166 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
6167 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
6168 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
6169 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
6170 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6171 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
6172 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6173 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
6174 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
6175 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
6176 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
6177 const char *, const char *,
6178 const char *);
6179 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
6180 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
6182 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6183 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
6184 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
6185 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
6186 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
6187 static void prune_unused_types (void);
6188 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
6189 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
6190 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
6192 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
6193 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
6194 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
6195 #endif
6196 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
6197 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
6198 #endif
6199 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
6200 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
6201 #endif
6202 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
6203 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
6204 #endif
6205 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
6206 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
6207 #endif
6208 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
6209 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
6210 #endif
6211 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
6212 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
6213 #endif
6214 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
6215 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION ".debug_pubtypes"
6216 #endif
6217 #ifndef DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION
6218 #define DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION ".debug_dcall"
6219 #endif
6220 #ifndef DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION
6221 #define DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION ".debug_vcall"
6222 #endif
6223 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
6224 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
6225 #endif
6226 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
6227 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
6228 #endif
6230 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
6231 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6232 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
6233 #endif
6235 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
6236 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
6237 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
6238 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
6239 : SECTION_DEBUG)
6241 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
6242 the section names themselves. */
6244 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6245 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
6246 #endif
6247 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6248 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
6249 #endif
6250 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
6251 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
6252 #endif
6253 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
6254 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
6255 #endif
6256 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
6257 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
6258 #endif
6259 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
6260 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
6261 #endif
6262 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
6263 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
6264 #endif
6265 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
6266 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
6267 #endif
6269 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
6270 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
6271 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
6272 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
6273 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
6275 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6276 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6277 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6278 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6279 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6280 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6281 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6282 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6283 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6284 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6286 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
6287 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
6288 #endif
6289 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
6290 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
6291 #endif
6292 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
6293 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
6294 #endif
6295 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
6296 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
6297 #endif
6298 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
6299 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
6300 #endif
6301 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
6302 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
6303 #endif
6306 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
6307 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
6309 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
6311 void
6312 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
6314 demangle_name_func = func;
6317 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
6319 static inline int
6320 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
6322 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6323 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
6324 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
6327 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
6328 removed. */
6330 static inline tree
6331 type_main_variant (tree type)
6333 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6335 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
6336 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
6337 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
6338 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
6339 here. */
6340 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
6341 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
6342 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6344 return type;
6347 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
6349 static inline int
6350 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
6352 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
6354 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
6355 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
6358 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
6360 static const char *
6361 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
6363 switch (tag)
6365 case DW_TAG_padding:
6366 return "DW_TAG_padding";
6367 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6368 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
6369 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6370 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
6371 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
6372 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
6373 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6374 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
6375 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
6376 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
6377 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
6378 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
6379 case DW_TAG_label:
6380 return "DW_TAG_label";
6381 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
6382 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
6383 case DW_TAG_member:
6384 return "DW_TAG_member";
6385 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6386 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
6387 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6388 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
6389 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
6390 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
6391 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6392 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
6393 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6394 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
6395 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6396 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
6397 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6398 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
6399 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6400 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
6401 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
6402 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
6403 case DW_TAG_variant:
6404 return "DW_TAG_variant";
6405 case DW_TAG_common_block:
6406 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
6407 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
6408 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
6409 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
6410 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
6411 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
6412 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
6413 case DW_TAG_module:
6414 return "DW_TAG_module";
6415 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6416 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
6417 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6418 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
6419 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6420 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
6421 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
6422 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
6423 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
6424 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
6425 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6426 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
6427 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
6428 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
6429 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6430 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
6431 case DW_TAG_constant:
6432 return "DW_TAG_constant";
6433 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
6434 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
6435 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6436 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
6437 case DW_TAG_friend:
6438 return "DW_TAG_friend";
6439 case DW_TAG_namelist:
6440 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
6441 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
6442 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
6443 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6444 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
6445 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
6446 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
6447 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
6448 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
6449 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
6450 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
6451 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
6452 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
6453 case DW_TAG_try_block:
6454 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
6455 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
6456 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
6457 case DW_TAG_variable:
6458 return "DW_TAG_variable";
6459 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6460 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
6461 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
6462 return "DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure";
6463 case DW_TAG_restrict_type:
6464 return "DW_TAG_restrict_type";
6465 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6466 return "DW_TAG_interface_type";
6467 case DW_TAG_namespace:
6468 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
6469 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
6470 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
6471 case DW_TAG_unspecified_type:
6472 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_type";
6473 case DW_TAG_partial_unit:
6474 return "DW_TAG_partial_unit";
6475 case DW_TAG_imported_unit:
6476 return "DW_TAG_imported_unit";
6477 case DW_TAG_condition:
6478 return "DW_TAG_condition";
6479 case DW_TAG_shared_type:
6480 return "DW_TAG_shared_type";
6481 case DW_TAG_type_unit:
6482 return "DW_TAG_type_unit";
6483 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6484 return "DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type";
6485 case DW_TAG_template_alias:
6486 return "DW_TAG_template_alias";
6487 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
6488 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack";
6489 case DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack:
6490 return "DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack";
6491 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
6492 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
6493 case DW_TAG_format_label:
6494 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
6495 case DW_TAG_function_template:
6496 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
6497 case DW_TAG_class_template:
6498 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
6499 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
6500 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
6501 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
6502 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
6503 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
6504 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param";
6505 default:
6506 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
6510 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
6512 static const char *
6513 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
6515 switch (attr)
6517 case DW_AT_sibling:
6518 return "DW_AT_sibling";
6519 case DW_AT_location:
6520 return "DW_AT_location";
6521 case DW_AT_name:
6522 return "DW_AT_name";
6523 case DW_AT_ordering:
6524 return "DW_AT_ordering";
6525 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
6526 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
6527 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6528 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
6529 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6530 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
6531 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6532 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
6533 case DW_AT_element_list:
6534 return "DW_AT_element_list";
6535 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
6536 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
6537 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6538 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
6539 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6540 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
6541 case DW_AT_language:
6542 return "DW_AT_language";
6543 case DW_AT_member:
6544 return "DW_AT_member";
6545 case DW_AT_discr:
6546 return "DW_AT_discr";
6547 case DW_AT_discr_value:
6548 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
6549 case DW_AT_visibility:
6550 return "DW_AT_visibility";
6551 case DW_AT_import:
6552 return "DW_AT_import";
6553 case DW_AT_string_length:
6554 return "DW_AT_string_length";
6555 case DW_AT_common_reference:
6556 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
6557 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
6558 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
6559 case DW_AT_const_value:
6560 return "DW_AT_const_value";
6561 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6562 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
6563 case DW_AT_default_value:
6564 return "DW_AT_default_value";
6565 case DW_AT_inline:
6566 return "DW_AT_inline";
6567 case DW_AT_is_optional:
6568 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
6569 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
6570 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
6571 case DW_AT_producer:
6572 return "DW_AT_producer";
6573 case DW_AT_prototyped:
6574 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
6575 case DW_AT_return_addr:
6576 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
6577 case DW_AT_start_scope:
6578 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
6579 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6580 return "DW_AT_bit_stride";
6581 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
6582 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
6583 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
6584 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
6585 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6586 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
6587 case DW_AT_address_class:
6588 return "DW_AT_address_class";
6589 case DW_AT_artificial:
6590 return "DW_AT_artificial";
6591 case DW_AT_base_types:
6592 return "DW_AT_base_types";
6593 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
6594 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
6595 case DW_AT_count:
6596 return "DW_AT_count";
6597 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
6598 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
6599 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6600 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
6601 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6602 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
6603 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6604 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
6605 case DW_AT_declaration:
6606 return "DW_AT_declaration";
6607 case DW_AT_discr_list:
6608 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
6609 case DW_AT_encoding:
6610 return "DW_AT_encoding";
6611 case DW_AT_external:
6612 return "DW_AT_external";
6613 case DW_AT_explicit:
6614 return "DW_AT_explicit";
6615 case DW_AT_frame_base:
6616 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
6617 case DW_AT_friend:
6618 return "DW_AT_friend";
6619 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
6620 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
6621 case DW_AT_macro_info:
6622 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
6623 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
6624 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
6625 case DW_AT_priority:
6626 return "DW_AT_priority";
6627 case DW_AT_segment:
6628 return "DW_AT_segment";
6629 case DW_AT_specification:
6630 return "DW_AT_specification";
6631 case DW_AT_static_link:
6632 return "DW_AT_static_link";
6633 case DW_AT_type:
6634 return "DW_AT_type";
6635 case DW_AT_use_location:
6636 return "DW_AT_use_location";
6637 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
6638 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
6639 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6640 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
6641 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
6642 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
6644 case DW_AT_allocated:
6645 return "DW_AT_allocated";
6646 case DW_AT_associated:
6647 return "DW_AT_associated";
6648 case DW_AT_data_location:
6649 return "DW_AT_data_location";
6650 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6651 return "DW_AT_byte_stride";
6652 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
6653 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
6654 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
6655 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
6656 case DW_AT_extension:
6657 return "DW_AT_extension";
6658 case DW_AT_ranges:
6659 return "DW_AT_ranges";
6660 case DW_AT_trampoline:
6661 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
6662 case DW_AT_call_column:
6663 return "DW_AT_call_column";
6664 case DW_AT_call_file:
6665 return "DW_AT_call_file";
6666 case DW_AT_call_line:
6667 return "DW_AT_call_line";
6669 case DW_AT_signature:
6670 return "DW_AT_signature";
6671 case DW_AT_main_subprogram:
6672 return "DW_AT_main_subprogram";
6673 case DW_AT_data_bit_offset:
6674 return "DW_AT_data_bit_offset";
6675 case DW_AT_const_expr:
6676 return "DW_AT_const_expr";
6677 case DW_AT_enum_class:
6678 return "DW_AT_enum_class";
6679 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
6680 return "DW_AT_linkage_name";
6682 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
6683 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
6684 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
6685 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
6686 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
6687 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
6688 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
6689 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
6690 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
6691 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
6692 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
6693 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
6694 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
6695 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
6696 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
6697 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
6698 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
6699 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
6700 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
6701 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
6702 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
6703 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
6705 case DW_AT_sf_names:
6706 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
6707 case DW_AT_src_info:
6708 return "DW_AT_src_info";
6709 case DW_AT_mac_info:
6710 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
6711 case DW_AT_src_coords:
6712 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
6713 case DW_AT_body_begin:
6714 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
6715 case DW_AT_body_end:
6716 return "DW_AT_body_end";
6717 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
6718 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
6719 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by:
6720 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by";
6721 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by:
6722 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by";
6723 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded:
6724 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded";
6725 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded:
6726 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded";
6727 case DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded:
6728 return "DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded";
6729 case DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required:
6730 return "DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required";
6731 case DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required:
6732 return "DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required";
6733 case DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature:
6734 return "DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature";
6735 case DW_AT_GNU_template_name:
6736 return "DW_AT_GNU_template_name";
6738 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
6739 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
6741 default:
6742 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
6746 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
6748 static const char *
6749 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
6751 switch (form)
6753 case DW_FORM_addr:
6754 return "DW_FORM_addr";
6755 case DW_FORM_block2:
6756 return "DW_FORM_block2";
6757 case DW_FORM_block4:
6758 return "DW_FORM_block4";
6759 case DW_FORM_data2:
6760 return "DW_FORM_data2";
6761 case DW_FORM_data4:
6762 return "DW_FORM_data4";
6763 case DW_FORM_data8:
6764 return "DW_FORM_data8";
6765 case DW_FORM_string:
6766 return "DW_FORM_string";
6767 case DW_FORM_block:
6768 return "DW_FORM_block";
6769 case DW_FORM_block1:
6770 return "DW_FORM_block1";
6771 case DW_FORM_data1:
6772 return "DW_FORM_data1";
6773 case DW_FORM_flag:
6774 return "DW_FORM_flag";
6775 case DW_FORM_sdata:
6776 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
6777 case DW_FORM_strp:
6778 return "DW_FORM_strp";
6779 case DW_FORM_udata:
6780 return "DW_FORM_udata";
6781 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
6782 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
6783 case DW_FORM_ref1:
6784 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
6785 case DW_FORM_ref2:
6786 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
6787 case DW_FORM_ref4:
6788 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
6789 case DW_FORM_ref8:
6790 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
6791 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
6792 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
6793 case DW_FORM_indirect:
6794 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
6795 case DW_FORM_sec_offset:
6796 return "DW_FORM_sec_offset";
6797 case DW_FORM_exprloc:
6798 return "DW_FORM_exprloc";
6799 case DW_FORM_flag_present:
6800 return "DW_FORM_flag_present";
6801 case DW_FORM_ref_sig8:
6802 return "DW_FORM_ref_sig8";
6803 default:
6804 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
6808 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
6809 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
6810 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
6811 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
6812 given block. */
6814 static tree
6815 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
6817 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
6818 return NULL_TREE;
6820 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
6821 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
6822 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
6823 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
6824 return NULL_TREE;
6826 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
6827 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
6828 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
6830 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
6833 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
6834 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
6835 parameter. */
6837 static tree
6838 decl_class_context (tree decl)
6840 tree context = NULL_TREE;
6842 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
6843 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
6844 else
6845 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
6846 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
6848 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
6849 context = NULL_TREE;
6851 return context;
6854 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
6856 static inline void
6857 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
6859 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
6860 if (die == NULL)
6861 return;
6863 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
6864 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
6865 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
6868 static inline enum dw_val_class
6869 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
6871 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
6874 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
6876 static inline void
6877 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
6879 dw_attr_node attr;
6881 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6882 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
6883 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
6884 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6887 static inline unsigned
6888 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
6890 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
6891 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
6894 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
6896 static inline void
6897 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
6899 dw_attr_node attr;
6901 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6902 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
6903 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
6904 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6907 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
6908 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
6910 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
6911 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
6914 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
6916 static inline void
6917 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6918 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
6920 dw_attr_node attr;
6922 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6923 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
6924 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
6925 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6928 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6929 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
6931 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
6932 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
6935 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
6937 static inline void
6938 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6939 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
6941 dw_attr_node attr;
6943 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6944 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
6945 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
6946 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
6947 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6950 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
6952 static inline void
6953 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6954 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
6956 dw_attr_node attr;
6958 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6959 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
6960 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
6961 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
6962 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
6963 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6966 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
6968 static inline void
6969 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6970 unsigned char data8[8])
6972 dw_attr_node attr;
6974 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6975 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
6976 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
6977 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6980 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
6982 static hashval_t
6983 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
6985 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
6988 static int
6989 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
6991 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
6992 (const char *)x2) == 0;
6995 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
6997 static struct indirect_string_node *
6998 find_AT_string (const char *str)
7000 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7001 void **slot;
7003 if (! debug_str_hash)
7004 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
7005 debug_str_eq, NULL);
7007 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
7008 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
7009 if (*slot == NULL)
7011 node = (struct indirect_string_node *)
7012 ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
7013 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
7014 *slot = node;
7016 else
7017 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
7019 node->refcount++;
7020 return node;
7023 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
7025 static inline void
7026 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
7028 dw_attr_node attr;
7029 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7031 node = find_AT_string (str);
7033 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7034 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
7035 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
7036 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7039 /* Create a label for an indirect string node, ensuring it is going to
7040 be output, unless its reference count goes down to zero. */
7042 static inline void
7043 gen_label_for_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
7045 char label[32];
7047 if (node->label)
7048 return;
7050 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
7051 ++dw2_string_counter;
7052 node->label = xstrdup (label);
7055 /* Create a SYMBOL_REF rtx whose value is the initial address of a
7056 debug string STR. */
7058 static inline rtx
7059 get_debug_string_label (const char *str)
7061 struct indirect_string_node *node = find_AT_string (str);
7063 debug_str_hash_forced = true;
7065 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7067 return gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, node->label);
7070 static inline const char *
7071 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
7073 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7074 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
7077 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
7078 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
7080 static enum dwarf_form
7081 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
7083 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7084 unsigned int len;
7086 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7088 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
7089 if (node->form)
7090 return node->form;
7092 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
7094 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
7095 always better to put it inline. */
7096 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
7097 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7099 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
7100 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
7101 single module. */
7102 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
7103 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
7104 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
7105 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7107 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7109 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
7112 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7114 static inline void
7115 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7117 dw_attr_node attr;
7119 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7120 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
7121 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
7122 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
7123 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7126 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
7127 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
7129 static inline void
7130 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7132 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
7133 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
7134 targ_die->die_definition = die;
7137 static inline dw_die_ref
7138 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
7140 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7141 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
7144 static inline int
7145 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
7147 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7148 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
7150 return 0;
7153 static inline void
7154 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
7156 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7157 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
7160 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7162 static inline void
7163 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
7165 dw_attr_node attr;
7167 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7168 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
7169 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
7170 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7173 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
7175 static inline void
7176 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
7178 dw_attr_node attr;
7180 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7181 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
7182 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
7183 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7186 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
7187 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
7189 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7190 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
7193 static inline void
7194 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
7196 dw_attr_node attr;
7198 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7199 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
7200 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
7201 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7202 have_location_lists = true;
7205 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7206 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
7208 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7209 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7212 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
7214 static inline void
7215 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
7217 dw_attr_node attr;
7219 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7220 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
7221 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
7222 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7225 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
7227 static inline rtx
7228 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
7230 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
7231 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
7234 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
7236 static inline void
7237 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7238 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
7240 dw_attr_node attr;
7242 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7243 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
7244 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
7245 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7248 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
7250 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7251 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
7253 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
7254 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
7257 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
7259 static inline void
7260 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
7262 dw_attr_node attr;
7264 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7265 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
7266 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
7267 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7270 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7271 debug_line section. */
7273 static inline void
7274 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7275 const char *label)
7277 dw_attr_node attr;
7279 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7280 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
7281 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7282 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7285 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7286 debug_macinfo section. */
7288 static inline void
7289 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7290 const char *label)
7292 dw_attr_node attr;
7294 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7295 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
7296 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7297 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7300 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
7302 static inline void
7303 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7304 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7306 dw_attr_node attr;
7308 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7309 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
7310 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7311 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7314 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
7316 static void
7317 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7318 long unsigned int offset)
7320 dw_attr_node attr;
7322 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7323 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
7324 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7325 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7328 static inline const char *
7329 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
7331 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
7332 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
7333 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
7334 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
7337 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
7339 static dw_attr_ref
7340 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7342 dw_attr_ref a;
7343 unsigned ix;
7344 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
7346 if (! die)
7347 return NULL;
7349 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7350 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7351 return a;
7352 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
7353 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7354 spec = AT_ref (a);
7356 if (spec)
7357 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
7359 return NULL;
7362 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7363 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7364 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7366 static inline const char *
7367 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7369 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
7371 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7374 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7375 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7376 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7378 static inline const char *
7379 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7381 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
7383 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7386 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
7387 NULL if it is not present. */
7389 static inline const char *
7390 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7392 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7394 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
7397 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
7398 if it is not present. */
7400 static inline int
7401 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7403 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7405 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
7408 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
7409 if it is not present. */
7411 static inline unsigned
7412 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7414 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7416 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
7419 static inline dw_die_ref
7420 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7422 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7424 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
7427 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7428 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7430 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7432 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
7435 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
7437 static inline bool
7438 is_c_family (void)
7440 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7442 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
7443 || lang == DW_LANG_C99
7444 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
7447 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
7449 static inline bool
7450 is_cxx (void)
7452 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7454 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
7457 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
7459 static inline bool
7460 is_fortran (void)
7462 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7464 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
7465 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
7466 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
7469 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
7471 static inline bool
7472 is_java (void)
7474 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7476 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
7479 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
7481 static inline bool
7482 is_ada (void)
7484 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7486 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
7489 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
7491 static void
7492 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7494 dw_attr_ref a;
7495 unsigned ix;
7497 if (! die)
7498 return;
7500 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7501 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7503 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
7504 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
7505 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
7507 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
7508 that are needed. */
7509 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
7510 return;
7514 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
7515 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
7517 static void
7518 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
7520 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
7521 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
7522 if (prev == child)
7524 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
7525 prev = NULL;
7527 else
7528 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
7529 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
7530 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
7533 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
7534 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
7536 static void
7537 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
7539 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
7541 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
7542 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
7544 new_child->die_parent = parent;
7545 if (prev == old_child)
7547 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
7548 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
7550 else
7552 prev->die_sib = new_child;
7553 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
7555 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
7556 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
7559 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
7561 static void
7562 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
7564 dw_die_ref c;
7565 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
7566 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
7567 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
7570 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
7571 matches TAG. */
7573 static void
7574 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
7576 dw_die_ref c;
7578 c = die->die_child;
7579 if (c) do {
7580 dw_die_ref prev = c;
7581 c = c->die_sib;
7582 while (c->die_tag == tag)
7584 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7585 /* Might have removed every child. */
7586 if (c == c->die_sib)
7587 return;
7588 c = c->die_sib;
7590 } while (c != die->die_child);
7593 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
7595 static void
7596 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
7598 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
7599 if (! die || ! child_die)
7600 return;
7601 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
7603 child_die->die_parent = die;
7604 if (die->die_child)
7606 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
7607 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
7609 else
7610 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
7611 die->die_child = child_die;
7614 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
7615 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
7616 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
7618 static void
7619 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
7621 dw_die_ref p;
7623 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
7624 specification DIE at toplevel. */
7625 if (child->die_parent != parent)
7627 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
7629 if (tmp)
7630 child = tmp;
7633 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
7634 || (child->die_parent
7635 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
7637 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
7638 if (p->die_sib == child)
7640 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
7641 break;
7644 add_child_die (parent, child);
7647 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
7649 static inline dw_die_ref
7650 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
7652 dw_die_ref die = GGC_CNEW (die_node);
7654 die->die_tag = tag_value;
7656 if (parent_die != NULL)
7657 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
7658 else
7660 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
7662 limbo_node = GGC_CNEW (limbo_die_node);
7663 limbo_node->die = die;
7664 limbo_node->created_for = t;
7665 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
7666 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
7669 return die;
7672 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
7674 static inline dw_die_ref
7675 lookup_type_die (tree type)
7677 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
7680 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
7682 static inline void
7683 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
7685 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
7688 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
7690 static hashval_t
7691 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
7693 return (hashval_t) ((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
7696 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
7698 static int
7699 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7701 return (((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7704 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
7706 static inline dw_die_ref
7707 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
7709 return (dw_die_ref) htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7712 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
7714 static hashval_t
7715 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
7717 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
7720 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
7721 UID of decl *Y. */
7723 static int
7724 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7726 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7729 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
7731 static inline var_loc_list *
7732 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
7734 if (!decl_loc_table)
7735 return NULL;
7736 return (var_loc_list *)
7737 htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7740 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
7742 static void
7743 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
7745 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
7746 void **slot;
7748 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
7749 *slot = decl_die;
7750 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
7753 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
7755 static void
7756 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
7758 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
7759 var_loc_list *temp;
7760 void **slot;
7762 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
7763 if (*slot == NULL)
7765 temp = GGC_CNEW (var_loc_list);
7766 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
7767 *slot = temp;
7769 else
7770 temp = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
7772 if (temp->last)
7774 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
7775 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
7776 we have nothing to do. */
7777 if ((!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
7778 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
7779 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->last->var_loc_note)
7780 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc->var_loc_note))
7781 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->last->var_loc_note)
7782 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
7783 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc->var_loc_note)
7784 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
7786 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
7787 temp->last->next = loc;
7788 temp->last = loc;
7791 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
7792 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
7794 temp->first = loc;
7795 temp->last = loc;
7799 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
7800 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
7801 the DIE internal representation. */
7802 static int print_indent;
7804 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
7806 static inline void
7807 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
7809 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
7812 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
7814 static inline void
7815 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
7817 int i;
7819 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
7820 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
7823 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
7824 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
7826 static void
7827 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
7829 dw_attr_ref a;
7830 dw_die_ref c;
7831 unsigned ix;
7833 print_spaces (outfile);
7834 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
7835 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7836 print_spaces (outfile);
7837 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
7838 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
7839 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && die->die_id.die_type_node)
7841 print_spaces (outfile);
7842 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
7843 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
7844 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
7847 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7849 print_spaces (outfile);
7850 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
7852 switch (AT_class (a))
7854 case dw_val_class_addr:
7855 fprintf (outfile, "address");
7856 break;
7857 case dw_val_class_offset:
7858 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
7859 break;
7860 case dw_val_class_loc:
7861 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
7862 break;
7863 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7864 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
7865 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
7866 break;
7867 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7868 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
7869 break;
7870 case dw_val_class_const:
7871 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
7872 break;
7873 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7874 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
7875 break;
7876 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7877 fprintf (outfile, "constant ("HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
7878 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
7879 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high,
7880 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low);
7881 break;
7882 case dw_val_class_vec:
7883 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
7884 break;
7885 case dw_val_class_flag:
7886 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
7887 break;
7888 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7889 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
7891 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node)
7893 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
7894 print_signature (outfile,
7895 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
7897 else if (dwarf_version < 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol)
7898 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s",
7899 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
7900 else
7901 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7903 else
7904 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
7905 break;
7906 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7907 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7908 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7909 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
7910 break;
7911 case dw_val_class_str:
7912 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
7913 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
7914 else
7915 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
7916 break;
7917 case dw_val_class_file:
7918 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
7919 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
7920 break;
7921 case dw_val_class_data8:
7923 int i;
7925 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
7926 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i]);
7927 break;
7929 default:
7930 break;
7933 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
7936 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7938 print_indent += 4;
7939 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
7940 print_indent -= 4;
7942 if (print_indent == 0)
7943 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
7946 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
7947 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
7949 static void
7950 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
7952 unsigned i;
7953 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
7955 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
7956 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
7958 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
7959 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
7960 line_info->dw_file_num,
7961 line_info->dw_line_num);
7964 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
7967 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
7969 void
7970 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
7972 print_die (die, stderr);
7975 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
7976 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
7978 void
7979 debug_dwarf (void)
7981 print_indent = 0;
7982 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
7983 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
7984 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
7987 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
7988 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
7989 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
7991 static dw_die_ref
7992 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
7994 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
7995 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
7997 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
7998 return new_unit;
8001 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
8003 static dw_die_ref
8004 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
8006 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
8008 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
8009 return new_unit;
8012 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8013 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
8015 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8017 static inline void
8018 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8020 int tem;
8022 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
8023 CHECKSUM (tem);
8024 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8025 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8028 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8030 static void
8031 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8033 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8034 rtx r;
8036 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
8038 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
8039 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
8040 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
8041 return;
8043 switch (AT_class (at))
8045 case dw_val_class_const:
8046 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8047 break;
8048 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8049 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8050 break;
8051 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8052 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8053 break;
8054 case dw_val_class_vec:
8055 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8056 break;
8057 case dw_val_class_flag:
8058 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
8059 break;
8060 case dw_val_class_str:
8061 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8062 break;
8064 case dw_val_class_addr:
8065 r = AT_addr (at);
8066 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8067 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8068 break;
8070 case dw_val_class_offset:
8071 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8072 break;
8074 case dw_val_class_loc:
8075 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8076 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
8077 break;
8079 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8080 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
8081 break;
8083 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8084 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8085 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8086 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8087 break;
8089 case dw_val_class_file:
8090 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8091 break;
8093 case dw_val_class_data8:
8094 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8095 break;
8097 default:
8098 break;
8102 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
8104 static void
8105 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8107 dw_die_ref c;
8108 dw_attr_ref a;
8109 unsigned ix;
8111 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
8112 if (die->die_mark)
8114 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
8115 return;
8117 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8119 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
8121 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
8122 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
8124 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
8127 #undef CHECKSUM
8128 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
8130 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
8131 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8132 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
8133 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8134 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8135 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
8136 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
8138 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
8140 static void
8141 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8143 unsigned char byte;
8144 bool more;
8146 while (1)
8148 byte = (value & 0x7f);
8149 value >>= 7;
8150 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
8151 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
8152 if (more)
8153 byte |= 0x80;
8154 CHECKSUM (byte);
8155 if (!more)
8156 break;
8160 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
8162 static void
8163 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8165 while (1)
8167 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
8168 value >>= 7;
8169 if (value != 0)
8170 /* More bytes to follow. */
8171 byte |= 0x80;
8172 CHECKSUM (byte);
8173 if (value == 0)
8174 break;
8178 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
8179 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
8181 static void
8182 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8184 const char *name;
8185 dw_die_ref spec;
8186 int tag = die->die_tag;
8188 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
8189 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
8190 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
8191 return;
8193 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
8195 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8196 if (spec != NULL)
8197 die = spec;
8199 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
8200 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
8202 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
8203 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
8204 if (name != NULL)
8205 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
8208 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8210 static inline void
8211 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8213 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
8214 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
8215 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
8217 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8218 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
8219 return;
8222 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
8223 while (loc != NULL)
8225 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
8226 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8227 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8228 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
8232 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8234 static void
8235 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_ref at,
8236 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8238 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8239 rtx r;
8241 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8243 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
8245 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
8246 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
8247 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
8248 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
8249 is complete or not. */
8250 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
8251 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
8252 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
8253 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
8254 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
8255 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
8257 dw_attr_ref name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
8259 if (name_attr != NULL)
8261 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8263 if (decl == NULL)
8264 decl = target_die;
8265 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
8266 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8267 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8268 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8269 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
8270 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
8271 return;
8275 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
8276 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
8277 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
8278 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
8280 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
8281 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8282 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
8284 else
8286 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8288 if (decl == NULL)
8289 decl = target_die;
8290 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8291 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
8292 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8293 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8294 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8295 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
8297 return;
8300 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
8301 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8303 switch (AT_class (at))
8305 case dw_val_class_const:
8306 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8307 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8308 break;
8310 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8311 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8312 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8313 break;
8315 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8316 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8317 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
8318 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8319 break;
8321 case dw_val_class_vec:
8322 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8323 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec));
8324 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8325 break;
8327 case dw_val_class_flag:
8328 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
8329 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
8330 break;
8332 case dw_val_class_str:
8333 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8334 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8335 break;
8337 case dw_val_class_addr:
8338 r = AT_addr (at);
8339 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8340 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8341 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8342 break;
8344 case dw_val_class_offset:
8345 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8346 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8347 break;
8349 case dw_val_class_loc:
8350 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8351 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
8352 break;
8354 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8355 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8356 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8357 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8358 break;
8360 case dw_val_class_file:
8361 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8362 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8363 break;
8365 case dw_val_class_data8:
8366 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8367 break;
8369 default:
8370 break;
8374 struct checksum_attributes
8376 dw_attr_ref at_name;
8377 dw_attr_ref at_type;
8378 dw_attr_ref at_friend;
8379 dw_attr_ref at_accessibility;
8380 dw_attr_ref at_address_class;
8381 dw_attr_ref at_allocated;
8382 dw_attr_ref at_artificial;
8383 dw_attr_ref at_associated;
8384 dw_attr_ref at_binary_scale;
8385 dw_attr_ref at_bit_offset;
8386 dw_attr_ref at_bit_size;
8387 dw_attr_ref at_bit_stride;
8388 dw_attr_ref at_byte_size;
8389 dw_attr_ref at_byte_stride;
8390 dw_attr_ref at_const_value;
8391 dw_attr_ref at_containing_type;
8392 dw_attr_ref at_count;
8393 dw_attr_ref at_data_location;
8394 dw_attr_ref at_data_member_location;
8395 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_scale;
8396 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_sign;
8397 dw_attr_ref at_default_value;
8398 dw_attr_ref at_digit_count;
8399 dw_attr_ref at_discr;
8400 dw_attr_ref at_discr_list;
8401 dw_attr_ref at_discr_value;
8402 dw_attr_ref at_encoding;
8403 dw_attr_ref at_endianity;
8404 dw_attr_ref at_explicit;
8405 dw_attr_ref at_is_optional;
8406 dw_attr_ref at_location;
8407 dw_attr_ref at_lower_bound;
8408 dw_attr_ref at_mutable;
8409 dw_attr_ref at_ordering;
8410 dw_attr_ref at_picture_string;
8411 dw_attr_ref at_prototyped;
8412 dw_attr_ref at_small;
8413 dw_attr_ref at_segment;
8414 dw_attr_ref at_string_length;
8415 dw_attr_ref at_threads_scaled;
8416 dw_attr_ref at_upper_bound;
8417 dw_attr_ref at_use_location;
8418 dw_attr_ref at_use_UTF8;
8419 dw_attr_ref at_variable_parameter;
8420 dw_attr_ref at_virtuality;
8421 dw_attr_ref at_visibility;
8422 dw_attr_ref at_vtable_elem_location;
8425 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
8427 static void
8428 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
8430 dw_attr_ref a;
8431 unsigned ix;
8433 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
8435 switch (a->dw_attr)
8437 case DW_AT_name:
8438 attrs->at_name = a;
8439 break;
8440 case DW_AT_type:
8441 attrs->at_type = a;
8442 break;
8443 case DW_AT_friend:
8444 attrs->at_friend = a;
8445 break;
8446 case DW_AT_accessibility:
8447 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
8448 break;
8449 case DW_AT_address_class:
8450 attrs->at_address_class = a;
8451 break;
8452 case DW_AT_allocated:
8453 attrs->at_allocated = a;
8454 break;
8455 case DW_AT_artificial:
8456 attrs->at_artificial = a;
8457 break;
8458 case DW_AT_associated:
8459 attrs->at_associated = a;
8460 break;
8461 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
8462 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
8463 break;
8464 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
8465 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
8466 break;
8467 case DW_AT_bit_size:
8468 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
8469 break;
8470 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
8471 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
8472 break;
8473 case DW_AT_byte_size:
8474 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
8475 break;
8476 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
8477 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
8478 break;
8479 case DW_AT_const_value:
8480 attrs->at_const_value = a;
8481 break;
8482 case DW_AT_containing_type:
8483 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
8484 break;
8485 case DW_AT_count:
8486 attrs->at_count = a;
8487 break;
8488 case DW_AT_data_location:
8489 attrs->at_data_location = a;
8490 break;
8491 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
8492 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
8493 break;
8494 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
8495 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
8496 break;
8497 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
8498 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
8499 break;
8500 case DW_AT_default_value:
8501 attrs->at_default_value = a;
8502 break;
8503 case DW_AT_digit_count:
8504 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
8505 break;
8506 case DW_AT_discr:
8507 attrs->at_discr = a;
8508 break;
8509 case DW_AT_discr_list:
8510 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
8511 break;
8512 case DW_AT_discr_value:
8513 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
8514 break;
8515 case DW_AT_encoding:
8516 attrs->at_encoding = a;
8517 break;
8518 case DW_AT_endianity:
8519 attrs->at_endianity = a;
8520 break;
8521 case DW_AT_explicit:
8522 attrs->at_explicit = a;
8523 break;
8524 case DW_AT_is_optional:
8525 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
8526 break;
8527 case DW_AT_location:
8528 attrs->at_location = a;
8529 break;
8530 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
8531 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
8532 break;
8533 case DW_AT_mutable:
8534 attrs->at_mutable = a;
8535 break;
8536 case DW_AT_ordering:
8537 attrs->at_ordering = a;
8538 break;
8539 case DW_AT_picture_string:
8540 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
8541 break;
8542 case DW_AT_prototyped:
8543 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
8544 break;
8545 case DW_AT_small:
8546 attrs->at_small = a;
8547 break;
8548 case DW_AT_segment:
8549 attrs->at_segment = a;
8550 break;
8551 case DW_AT_string_length:
8552 attrs->at_string_length = a;
8553 break;
8554 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
8555 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
8556 break;
8557 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
8558 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
8559 break;
8560 case DW_AT_use_location:
8561 attrs->at_use_location = a;
8562 break;
8563 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
8564 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
8565 break;
8566 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
8567 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
8568 break;
8569 case DW_AT_virtuality:
8570 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
8571 break;
8572 case DW_AT_visibility:
8573 attrs->at_visibility = a;
8574 break;
8575 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
8576 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
8577 break;
8578 default:
8579 break;
8584 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
8586 static void
8587 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8589 dw_die_ref c;
8590 dw_die_ref decl;
8591 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
8593 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
8594 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
8596 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
8598 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8599 if (decl != NULL)
8600 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
8601 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
8603 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
8604 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
8605 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
8606 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
8607 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
8608 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
8609 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
8610 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
8611 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
8612 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
8613 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
8614 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
8615 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
8616 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
8617 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
8618 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
8619 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
8620 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
8621 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
8622 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
8623 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
8624 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
8625 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
8626 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
8627 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
8628 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
8629 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
8630 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
8631 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
8632 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
8633 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
8634 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
8635 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
8636 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
8637 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
8638 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
8639 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
8640 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
8641 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
8642 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
8643 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
8644 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
8645 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
8646 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
8647 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
8648 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
8649 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
8651 /* Checksum the child DIEs, except for nested types and member functions. */
8652 c = die->die_child;
8653 if (c) do {
8654 dw_attr_ref name_attr;
8656 c = c->die_sib;
8657 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
8658 if ((is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
8659 && name_attr != NULL)
8661 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
8662 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
8663 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
8665 else
8667 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
8668 if (c->die_mark == 0)
8669 c->die_mark = -1;
8670 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
8672 } while (c != die->die_child);
8674 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
8677 #undef CHECKSUM
8678 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
8679 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
8680 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
8681 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
8683 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
8684 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
8685 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
8686 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
8687 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
8688 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
8689 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
8691 static void
8692 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
8694 int mark;
8695 const char *name;
8696 unsigned char checksum[16];
8697 struct md5_ctx ctx;
8698 dw_die_ref decl;
8700 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
8701 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8703 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
8704 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
8705 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
8707 if (is_cxx() && name != NULL)
8709 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
8711 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
8712 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
8713 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
8715 md5_process_bytes (&die->die_tag, sizeof (die->die_tag), &ctx);
8716 md5_process_bytes (name, strlen (name) + 1, &ctx);
8717 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
8719 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
8722 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
8724 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
8725 mark = 1;
8726 die->die_mark = mark;
8728 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
8729 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
8730 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
8732 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
8733 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
8734 unmark_all_dies (die);
8735 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
8737 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
8738 type node together. */
8739 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
8740 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
8741 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
8742 type_node->type_die = die;
8744 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
8745 as well. */
8746 if (decl != NULL)
8747 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
8750 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
8751 static inline int
8752 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
8754 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
8755 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
8756 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
8759 /* Do the values look the same? */
8760 static int
8761 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
8763 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
8764 rtx r1, r2;
8766 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
8767 return 0;
8769 switch (v1->val_class)
8771 case dw_val_class_const:
8772 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
8773 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8774 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
8775 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8776 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
8777 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
8778 case dw_val_class_vec:
8779 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
8780 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
8781 return 0;
8782 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
8783 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
8784 return 0;
8785 return 1;
8786 case dw_val_class_flag:
8787 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
8788 case dw_val_class_str:
8789 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
8791 case dw_val_class_addr:
8792 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
8793 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
8794 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
8795 return 0;
8796 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
8798 case dw_val_class_offset:
8799 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
8801 case dw_val_class_loc:
8802 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
8803 loc1 && loc2;
8804 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
8805 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
8806 return 0;
8807 return !loc1 && !loc2;
8809 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8810 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
8812 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8813 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8814 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8815 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8816 return 1;
8818 case dw_val_class_file:
8819 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
8821 case dw_val_class_data8:
8822 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
8824 default:
8825 return 1;
8829 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
8831 static int
8832 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
8834 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
8835 return 0;
8837 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
8838 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
8839 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
8840 return 1;
8842 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
8845 /* Do the dies look the same? */
8847 static int
8848 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
8850 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
8851 dw_attr_ref a1;
8852 unsigned ix;
8854 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
8855 if (die1->die_mark)
8856 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
8857 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8859 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
8860 return 0;
8862 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
8863 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
8864 return 0;
8866 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
8867 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
8868 return 0;
8870 c1 = die1->die_child;
8871 c2 = die2->die_child;
8872 if (! c1)
8874 if (c2)
8875 return 0;
8877 else
8878 for (;;)
8880 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
8881 return 0;
8882 c1 = c1->die_sib;
8883 c2 = c2->die_sib;
8884 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
8886 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
8887 break;
8888 else
8889 return 0;
8893 return 1;
8896 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
8898 static int
8899 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
8901 int mark = 0;
8902 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
8904 unmark_all_dies (die1);
8905 unmark_all_dies (die2);
8907 return ret;
8910 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
8911 info section. */
8912 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
8914 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
8915 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
8917 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
8918 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
8920 static void
8921 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
8923 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
8924 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
8925 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
8926 char *p;
8927 int i, mark;
8928 unsigned char checksum[16];
8929 struct md5_ctx ctx;
8931 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
8932 the name filename of the unit. */
8934 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
8935 mark = 0;
8936 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
8937 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
8938 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
8940 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
8941 clean_symbol_name (name);
8943 p = name + strlen (name);
8944 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
8946 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
8947 p += 2;
8950 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
8951 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
8954 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
8956 static int
8957 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
8959 switch (die->die_tag)
8961 case DW_TAG_array_type:
8962 case DW_TAG_class_type:
8963 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
8964 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
8965 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
8966 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
8967 case DW_TAG_string_type:
8968 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
8969 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
8970 case DW_TAG_union_type:
8971 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
8972 case DW_TAG_set_type:
8973 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
8974 case DW_TAG_base_type:
8975 case DW_TAG_const_type:
8976 case DW_TAG_file_type:
8977 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
8978 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
8979 case DW_TAG_typedef:
8980 return 1;
8981 default:
8982 return 0;
8986 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
8987 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
8988 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
8989 compilations (functions). */
8991 static int
8992 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
8994 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
8995 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
8996 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
8997 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
8999 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
9000 return 0;
9002 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
9003 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
9004 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
9005 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
9007 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
9009 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
9012 return is_type_die (c);
9015 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
9016 compilation unit. */
9018 static int
9019 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
9021 return (is_type_die (c)
9022 || is_declaration_die (c)
9023 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9024 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
9027 static char *
9028 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
9030 char buf[256];
9032 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
9033 return xstrdup (buf);
9036 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
9038 static void
9039 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
9041 dw_die_ref c;
9043 if (is_symbol_die (die))
9045 if (comdat_symbol_id)
9047 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
9049 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
9050 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
9051 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
9053 else
9054 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
9057 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
9060 struct cu_hash_table_entry
9062 dw_die_ref cu;
9063 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
9064 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
9067 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
9068 static hashval_t
9069 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
9071 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry =
9072 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of;
9074 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
9077 static int
9078 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
9080 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry1 =
9081 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of1;
9082 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
9084 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
9087 static void
9088 htab_cu_del (void *what)
9090 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next,
9091 *entry = (struct cu_hash_table_entry *) what;
9093 while (entry)
9095 next = entry->next;
9096 free (entry);
9097 entry = next;
9101 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
9102 accordingly. */
9103 static int
9104 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
9106 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
9107 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
9109 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
9111 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9112 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9113 INSERT);
9114 entry = *slot;
9116 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
9118 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
9119 break;
9122 if (entry)
9124 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
9125 return 1;
9128 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
9129 entry->cu = cu;
9130 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
9131 entry->next = *slot;
9132 *slot = entry;
9134 return 0;
9137 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
9138 static void
9139 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
9141 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
9143 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9144 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9145 NO_INSERT);
9146 entry = *slot;
9148 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
9151 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
9152 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
9153 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
9155 static void
9156 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
9158 dw_die_ref c;
9159 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
9160 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
9161 htab_t cu_hash_table;
9163 c = die->die_child;
9164 if (c) do {
9165 dw_die_ref prev = c;
9166 c = c->die_sib;
9167 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
9168 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
9170 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
9172 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
9173 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
9175 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
9176 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
9177 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
9178 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
9179 else
9180 add_child_die (unit, c);
9181 c = next;
9182 if (c == die->die_child)
9183 break;
9185 } while (c != die->die_child);
9187 #if 0
9188 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
9189 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
9190 gcc_assert (!unit);
9191 #endif
9193 assign_symbol_names (die);
9194 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
9195 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
9196 node;
9197 node = node->next)
9199 int is_dupl;
9201 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
9202 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9203 &comdat_symbol_number);
9204 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
9205 if (is_dupl)
9206 *pnode = node->next;
9207 else
9209 pnode = &node->next;
9210 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9211 comdat_symbol_number);
9214 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
9217 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
9219 static int
9220 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
9222 dw_attr_ref a;
9223 unsigned ix;
9225 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9226 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
9227 return 1;
9229 return 0;
9232 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
9233 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
9235 static int
9236 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
9238 switch (die->die_tag)
9240 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9241 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9242 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9243 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9244 /* Don't move declarations or inlined instances. */
9245 if (is_declaration_die (die) || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
9246 return 0;
9247 return 1;
9248 case DW_TAG_array_type:
9249 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9250 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
9251 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
9252 case DW_TAG_string_type:
9253 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
9254 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
9255 case DW_TAG_set_type:
9256 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9257 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9258 case DW_TAG_const_type:
9259 case DW_TAG_file_type:
9260 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
9261 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
9262 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9263 default:
9264 return 0;
9268 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
9270 static dw_die_ref
9271 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
9273 dw_die_ref clone;
9274 dw_attr_ref a;
9275 unsigned ix;
9277 clone = GGC_CNEW (die_node);
9278 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9280 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9281 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9283 return clone;
9286 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
9288 static dw_die_ref
9289 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
9291 dw_die_ref c;
9292 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
9294 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree(c)));
9296 return clone;
9299 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
9301 static dw_die_ref
9302 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
9304 dw_die_ref clone;
9305 dw_die_ref decl;
9306 dw_attr_ref a;
9307 unsigned ix;
9309 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
9310 if (is_declaration_die (die))
9311 return clone_die (die);
9313 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
9314 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9315 if (decl != NULL)
9316 return clone_die (decl);
9318 clone = GGC_CNEW (die_node);
9319 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9321 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9323 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
9324 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
9325 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
9327 switch (a->dw_attr)
9329 case DW_AT_artificial:
9330 case DW_AT_containing_type:
9331 case DW_AT_external:
9332 case DW_AT_name:
9333 case DW_AT_type:
9334 case DW_AT_virtuality:
9335 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
9336 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9337 break;
9338 case DW_AT_byte_size:
9339 default:
9340 break;
9344 if (die->die_id.die_type_node)
9345 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
9347 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9348 return clone;
9351 /* Copy the declaration context to the new compile unit DIE. This includes
9352 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
9353 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
9354 attached to the specification. */
9356 static void
9357 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
9359 dw_die_ref decl;
9360 dw_die_ref new_decl;
9362 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9363 if (decl == NULL)
9364 decl = die;
9365 else
9367 unsigned ix;
9368 dw_die_ref c;
9369 dw_attr_ref a;
9371 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
9372 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
9373 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
9375 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
9377 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, decl->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9379 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
9380 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
9381 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
9382 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
9385 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree(c)));
9388 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
9389 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9390 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9392 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
9393 if (new_decl != NULL)
9395 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
9396 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
9401 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
9402 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
9404 static void
9405 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
9407 if (node->new_die != NULL)
9408 return;
9410 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
9412 if (node->parent != NULL)
9414 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
9415 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
9419 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
9420 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
9421 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
9423 static void
9424 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
9426 skeleton_chain_node node;
9427 dw_die_ref c;
9428 dw_die_ref first;
9429 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
9430 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
9432 node.parent = parent;
9434 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
9435 if (c)
9436 next = c->die_sib;
9437 if (c) do {
9438 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
9439 prev = c;
9440 c = next;
9441 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
9442 node.old_die = c;
9443 node.new_die = NULL;
9444 if (is_declaration_die (c))
9446 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
9447 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
9448 all the original's children, where the original came from. */
9449 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
9450 move_all_children (c, clone);
9452 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
9453 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
9454 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
9455 node.new_die = c;
9456 c = clone;
9458 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9459 } while (next != NULL);
9462 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
9464 static dw_die_ref
9465 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
9467 skeleton_chain_node node;
9469 node.old_die = die;
9470 node.new_die = NULL;
9471 node.parent = NULL;
9473 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
9474 always leave at least a declaration in its place. */
9475 if (die->die_parent != NULL && is_type_die (die->die_parent))
9476 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
9478 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9479 return node.new_die;
9482 /* Remove the DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
9483 declaration. The original DIE will be moved to a new compile unit
9484 so that existing references to it follow it to the new location. If
9485 any of the original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to
9486 replace the original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the
9487 declarations back into the skeleton tree. */
9489 static dw_die_ref
9490 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
9492 dw_die_ref skeleton;
9494 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
9495 if (skeleton == NULL)
9496 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
9497 else
9499 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
9500 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
9503 return skeleton;
9506 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
9507 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
9509 static void
9510 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
9512 dw_die_ref c;
9513 dw_die_ref first;
9514 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
9515 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
9516 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
9518 first = c = die->die_child;
9519 if (c)
9520 next = c->die_sib;
9521 if (c) do {
9522 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
9523 prev = c;
9524 c = next;
9525 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
9526 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
9528 dw_die_ref replacement;
9529 comdat_type_node_ref type_node;
9531 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
9532 add it to the list of comdat types. */
9533 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
9534 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
9535 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language));
9536 type_node = GGC_CNEW (comdat_type_node);
9537 type_node->root_die = unit;
9538 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
9539 comdat_type_list = type_node;
9541 /* Generate the type signature. */
9542 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
9544 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
9545 declaration into the new compile unit DIE. */
9546 copy_declaration_context (unit, c);
9548 /* Remove this DIE from the main CU. */
9549 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (c, prev);
9551 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
9552 break_out_comdat_types (c);
9554 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
9555 add_child_die (unit, c);
9557 if (replacement != NULL)
9558 c = replacement;
9560 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9561 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
9562 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
9563 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
9565 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
9566 break_out_comdat_types (c);
9568 } while (next != NULL);
9571 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
9573 struct decl_table_entry
9575 dw_die_ref orig;
9576 dw_die_ref copy;
9579 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
9581 static hashval_t
9582 htab_decl_hash (const void *of)
9584 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry =
9585 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of;
9587 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
9590 static int
9591 htab_decl_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
9593 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry1 =
9594 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of1;
9595 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
9597 return entry1->orig == entry2;
9600 static void
9601 htab_decl_del (void *what)
9603 struct decl_table_entry *entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) what;
9605 free (entry);
9608 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
9609 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
9610 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
9611 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
9613 static dw_die_ref
9614 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
9616 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
9617 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
9618 dw_die_ref copy;
9619 void **slot = NULL;
9620 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
9622 if (decl_table)
9624 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
9625 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, die,
9626 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
9627 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
9629 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
9630 return entry->copy;
9633 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
9634 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
9635 entry->orig = die;
9636 entry->copy = NULL;
9637 *slot = entry;
9640 if (parent != NULL)
9642 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
9643 if (spec != NULL)
9644 parent = spec;
9645 if (parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9646 && parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9647 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
9650 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
9651 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
9653 if (decl_table != NULL)
9655 /* Make sure the copy is marked as part of the type unit. */
9656 copy->die_mark = 1;
9657 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
9658 entry->copy = copy;
9661 return copy;
9664 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
9665 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
9666 type_unit). */
9668 static void
9669 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
9671 dw_die_ref c;
9672 dw_attr_ref a;
9673 unsigned ix;
9675 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9677 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9679 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
9680 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = targ->die_id.die_type_node;
9681 void **slot;
9682 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
9684 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || type_node != NULL)
9685 continue;
9687 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, targ,
9688 htab_hash_pointer (targ), INSERT);
9690 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
9692 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
9693 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
9694 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
9695 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
9697 else
9699 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
9700 dw_die_ref copy = clone_tree (targ);
9702 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
9703 type unit. */
9704 mark_dies (copy);
9706 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
9707 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
9708 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
9709 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
9710 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
9711 entry->orig = targ;
9712 entry->copy = copy;
9713 *slot = entry;
9715 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
9716 into the new type unit. */
9717 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
9718 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9719 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9720 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
9721 decl_table);
9723 add_child_die (parent, copy);
9724 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
9726 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
9727 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
9728 get visited otherwise. */
9729 if (parent != unit)
9730 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
9735 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
9738 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
9739 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
9740 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
9741 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
9742 don't have an external reference. */
9744 static void
9745 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
9747 htab_t decl_table;
9749 mark_dies (unit);
9750 decl_table = htab_create (10, htab_decl_hash, htab_decl_eq, htab_decl_del);
9751 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, decl_table);
9752 htab_delete (decl_table);
9753 unmark_dies (unit);
9756 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
9757 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
9758 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
9760 static void
9761 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
9763 dw_die_ref c;
9765 if (! die->die_child)
9766 return;
9768 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
9769 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
9771 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
9774 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
9776 static void
9777 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
9779 dw_die_ref c;
9780 dw_attr_ref a;
9781 unsigned ix;
9783 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9784 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
9785 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
9787 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
9790 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
9791 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
9792 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
9793 die are visited recursively. */
9795 static void
9796 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
9798 unsigned long abbrev_id;
9799 unsigned int n_alloc;
9800 dw_die_ref c;
9801 dw_attr_ref a;
9802 unsigned ix;
9804 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
9805 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
9806 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9807 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
9808 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
9810 gcc_assert (dwarf_version >= 4 || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
9811 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
9814 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
9816 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
9817 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
9818 unsigned ix;
9819 bool ok = true;
9821 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
9822 continue;
9823 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
9824 continue;
9826 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
9827 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
9828 continue;
9830 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
9832 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
9833 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
9834 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
9836 ok = false;
9837 break;
9840 if (ok)
9841 break;
9844 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
9846 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
9848 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
9849 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
9850 n_alloc);
9852 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
9853 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
9854 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
9857 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
9858 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
9861 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
9862 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
9865 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
9867 static int
9868 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
9870 int log;
9872 if (value == 0)
9873 log = 0;
9874 else
9875 log = floor_log2 (value);
9877 log = log / 8;
9878 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
9880 return log;
9883 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
9884 .debug_info section. */
9886 static unsigned long
9887 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
9889 unsigned long size = 0;
9890 dw_attr_ref a;
9891 unsigned ix;
9893 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
9894 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9896 switch (AT_class (a))
9898 case dw_val_class_addr:
9899 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9900 break;
9901 case dw_val_class_offset:
9902 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9903 break;
9904 case dw_val_class_loc:
9906 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
9908 /* Block length. */
9909 size += constant_size (lsize);
9910 size += lsize;
9912 break;
9913 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9914 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9915 break;
9916 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9917 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9918 break;
9919 case dw_val_class_const:
9920 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
9921 break;
9922 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9923 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9924 break;
9925 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9926 size += 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9927 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
9928 size++; /* block */
9929 break;
9930 case dw_val_class_vec:
9931 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9932 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
9933 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9934 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
9935 break;
9936 case dw_val_class_flag:
9937 size += 1;
9938 break;
9939 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9940 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9942 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_sig8; for earlier versions
9943 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
9944 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
9945 it's always sized as an offset. */
9946 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9947 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
9948 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
9949 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9950 else
9951 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9953 else
9954 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9955 break;
9956 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9957 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9958 break;
9959 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9960 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9961 break;
9962 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9963 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9964 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9965 break;
9966 case dw_val_class_str:
9967 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
9968 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9969 else
9970 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
9971 break;
9972 case dw_val_class_file:
9973 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
9974 break;
9975 case dw_val_class_data8:
9976 size += 8;
9977 break;
9978 default:
9979 gcc_unreachable ();
9983 return size;
9986 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
9987 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
9988 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
9989 die_offset field in each DIE. */
9991 static void
9992 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
9994 dw_die_ref c;
9996 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
9997 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
9999 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
10001 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10002 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
10003 next_die_offset += 1;
10006 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
10007 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
10008 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
10009 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
10011 static void
10012 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10014 dw_die_ref c;
10016 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
10018 die->die_mark = 1;
10019 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
10022 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
10024 static void
10025 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10027 dw_die_ref c;
10029 if (dwarf_version < 4)
10030 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
10032 die->die_mark = 0;
10033 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
10036 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
10038 static void
10039 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10041 dw_die_ref c;
10042 dw_attr_ref a;
10043 unsigned ix;
10045 if (!die->die_mark)
10046 return;
10047 die->die_mark = 0;
10049 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
10051 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10052 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
10053 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
10056 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
10057 generated for the compilation unit. */
10059 static unsigned long
10060 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
10062 unsigned long size;
10063 unsigned i;
10064 pubname_ref p;
10066 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
10067 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
10068 if (names != pubtype_table
10069 || p->die->die_offset != 0
10070 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
10071 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
10073 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10074 return size;
10077 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
10079 static unsigned long
10080 size_of_aranges (void)
10082 unsigned long size;
10084 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
10086 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
10087 if (text_section_used)
10088 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10089 if (cold_text_section_used)
10090 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10091 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
10093 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
10094 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10095 return size;
10098 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
10100 static enum dwarf_form
10101 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10103 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
10105 case dw_val_class_addr:
10106 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
10107 switch (a->dw_attr)
10109 case DW_AT_low_pc:
10110 case DW_AT_high_pc:
10111 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
10112 case DW_AT_trampoline:
10113 return DW_FORM_addr;
10114 default:
10115 break;
10117 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10119 case 1:
10120 return DW_FORM_data1;
10121 case 2:
10122 return DW_FORM_data2;
10123 case 4:
10124 return DW_FORM_data4;
10125 case 8:
10126 return DW_FORM_data8;
10127 default:
10128 gcc_unreachable ();
10130 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10131 case dw_val_class_offset:
10132 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10133 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
10135 case 4:
10136 return DW_FORM_data4;
10137 case 8:
10138 return DW_FORM_data8;
10139 default:
10140 gcc_unreachable ();
10142 case dw_val_class_loc:
10143 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
10145 case 1:
10146 return DW_FORM_block1;
10147 case 2:
10148 return DW_FORM_block2;
10149 default:
10150 gcc_unreachable ();
10152 case dw_val_class_const:
10153 return DW_FORM_sdata;
10154 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10155 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
10157 case 1:
10158 return DW_FORM_data1;
10159 case 2:
10160 return DW_FORM_data2;
10161 case 4:
10162 return DW_FORM_data4;
10163 case 8:
10164 return DW_FORM_data8;
10165 default:
10166 gcc_unreachable ();
10168 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10169 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10171 case 8:
10172 return DW_FORM_data2;
10173 case 16:
10174 return DW_FORM_data4;
10175 case 32:
10176 return DW_FORM_data8;
10177 case 64:
10178 default:
10179 return DW_FORM_block1;
10181 case dw_val_class_vec:
10182 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10183 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
10185 case 1:
10186 return DW_FORM_block1;
10187 case 2:
10188 return DW_FORM_block2;
10189 case 4:
10190 return DW_FORM_block4;
10191 default:
10192 gcc_unreachable ();
10194 case dw_val_class_flag:
10195 return DW_FORM_flag;
10196 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10197 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10198 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
10199 else
10200 return DW_FORM_ref;
10201 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10202 return DW_FORM_data;
10203 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10204 return DW_FORM_addr;
10205 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10206 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10207 return DW_FORM_data;
10208 case dw_val_class_str:
10209 return AT_string_form (a);
10210 case dw_val_class_file:
10211 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
10213 case 1:
10214 return DW_FORM_data1;
10215 case 2:
10216 return DW_FORM_data2;
10217 case 4:
10218 return DW_FORM_data4;
10219 default:
10220 gcc_unreachable ();
10223 case dw_val_class_data8:
10224 return DW_FORM_data8;
10226 default:
10227 gcc_unreachable ();
10231 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
10233 static void
10234 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10236 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
10238 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
10241 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
10242 table. */
10244 static void
10245 output_abbrev_section (void)
10247 unsigned long abbrev_id;
10249 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
10251 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
10252 unsigned ix;
10253 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
10255 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
10256 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
10257 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
10259 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
10260 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
10261 else
10262 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
10264 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
10265 ix++)
10267 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
10268 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
10269 output_value_format (a_attr);
10272 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10273 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10276 /* Terminate the table. */
10277 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10280 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
10282 static inline void
10283 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
10285 char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10287 if (sym == 0)
10288 return;
10290 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
10291 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
10292 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
10293 will break. */
10294 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
10296 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
10299 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
10300 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
10301 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
10303 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
10304 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
10305 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
10307 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_list_node);
10309 retlist->begin = begin;
10310 retlist->end = end;
10311 retlist->expr = expr;
10312 retlist->section = section;
10313 if (gensym)
10314 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
10316 return retlist;
10319 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
10321 static inline void
10322 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
10323 const char *begin, const char *end,
10324 const char *section)
10326 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
10328 /* Find the end of the chain. */
10329 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
10332 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
10333 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
10336 /* Output the location list given to us. */
10338 static void
10339 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
10341 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
10343 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
10345 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
10346 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10348 unsigned long size;
10349 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
10350 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0)
10351 continue;
10352 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10354 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
10355 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10356 list_head->ll_symbol);
10357 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
10358 "Location list end address (%s)",
10359 list_head->ll_symbol);
10361 else
10363 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10364 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10365 list_head->ll_symbol);
10366 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10367 "Location list end address (%s)",
10368 list_head->ll_symbol);
10370 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
10372 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10373 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
10374 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
10376 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
10379 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10380 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
10381 list_head->ll_symbol);
10382 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10383 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
10384 list_head->ll_symbol);
10387 /* Output a type signature. */
10389 static inline void
10390 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
10392 int i;
10394 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10395 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10398 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
10399 the definitions of each child DIE. */
10401 static void
10402 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
10404 dw_attr_ref a;
10405 dw_die_ref c;
10406 unsigned long size;
10407 unsigned ix;
10409 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
10410 them to point to. */
10411 if (dwarf_version < 4 && die->die_id.die_symbol)
10412 output_die_symbol (die);
10414 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
10415 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
10416 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
10418 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10420 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10422 switch (AT_class (a))
10424 case dw_val_class_addr:
10425 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
10426 break;
10428 case dw_val_class_offset:
10429 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10430 "%s", name);
10431 break;
10433 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10435 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
10437 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
10438 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
10439 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
10440 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10441 *p = '\0';
10443 break;
10445 case dw_val_class_loc:
10446 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10448 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10449 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10451 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
10452 break;
10454 case dw_val_class_const:
10455 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10456 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10457 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
10458 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10459 break;
10461 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10462 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
10463 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10464 break;
10466 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10468 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10470 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
10471 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10472 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10473 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10474 NULL);
10476 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10478 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10479 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10481 else
10483 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10484 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10487 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10488 first, name);
10489 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10490 second, NULL);
10492 break;
10494 case dw_val_class_vec:
10496 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10497 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10498 unsigned int i;
10499 unsigned char *p;
10501 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10502 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10503 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10505 elt_size /= 2;
10506 len *= 2;
10508 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10509 i < len;
10510 i++, p += elt_size)
10511 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10512 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10513 break;
10516 case dw_val_class_flag:
10517 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10518 break;
10520 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10522 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
10524 gcc_assert (sym);
10525 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
10526 "%s", name);
10528 break;
10530 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10531 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10533 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10535 comdat_type_node_ref type_node =
10536 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
10538 gcc_assert (type_node);
10539 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
10541 else
10543 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
10544 int size;
10546 gcc_assert (sym);
10547 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
10548 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
10549 offset. */
10550 if (dwarf_version == 2)
10551 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10552 else
10553 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10554 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
10555 name);
10558 else
10560 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
10561 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10562 "%s", name);
10564 break;
10566 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10568 char l1[20];
10570 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
10571 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
10572 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
10573 "%s", name);
10575 break;
10577 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10578 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
10579 break;
10581 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10582 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10583 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
10584 break;
10586 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10587 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10588 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
10589 break;
10591 case dw_val_class_str:
10592 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
10593 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10594 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10595 debug_str_section,
10596 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10597 else
10598 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
10599 break;
10601 case dw_val_class_file:
10603 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
10605 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
10606 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10607 break;
10610 case dw_val_class_data8:
10612 int i;
10614 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10615 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
10616 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10617 break;
10620 default:
10621 gcc_unreachable ();
10625 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
10627 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
10628 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10629 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
10630 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
10633 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
10634 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
10636 static void
10637 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
10639 int ver = dwarf_version;
10641 /* Don't mark the output as DWARF-4 until we make full use of the
10642 version 4 extensions, and gdb supports them. For now, -gdwarf-4
10643 selects only a few extensions from the DWARF-4 spec. */
10644 if (ver > 3)
10645 ver = 3;
10646 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10647 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10648 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10649 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10650 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
10651 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10652 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
10653 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
10654 debug_abbrev_section,
10655 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10656 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10659 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
10661 static void
10662 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
10664 const char *secname;
10665 char *oldsym, *tmp;
10667 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
10668 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
10669 return;
10671 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
10672 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
10673 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
10674 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
10675 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10676 mark_dies (die);
10678 build_abbrev_table (die);
10680 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10681 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
10682 calc_die_sizes (die);
10684 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10685 if (oldsym)
10687 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
10689 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
10690 secname = tmp;
10691 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
10692 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10694 else
10695 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
10697 /* Output debugging information. */
10698 output_compilation_unit_header ();
10699 output_die (die);
10701 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
10702 output_pubnames. */
10703 if (oldsym)
10705 unmark_dies (die);
10706 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
10710 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
10712 static void
10713 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
10715 const char *secname;
10716 char *tmp;
10717 int i;
10718 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10719 tree comdat_key;
10720 #endif
10722 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10723 mark_dies (node->root_die);
10725 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die);
10727 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10728 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
10729 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
10731 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10732 secname = ".debug_types";
10733 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10734 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
10735 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10736 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10737 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
10738 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
10739 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
10740 comdat_key);
10741 #else
10742 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10743 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
10744 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10745 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10746 secname = tmp;
10747 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10748 #endif
10750 /* Output debugging information. */
10751 output_compilation_unit_header ();
10752 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
10753 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
10754 "Offset to Type DIE");
10755 output_die (node->root_die);
10757 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
10760 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
10762 static const char *
10763 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
10765 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
10768 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
10770 static void
10771 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
10773 pubname_entry e;
10775 e.die = die;
10776 e.name = xstrdup (str);
10777 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
10780 static void
10781 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10783 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10785 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
10786 if (name)
10787 add_pubname_string (name, die);
10791 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
10793 static void
10794 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10796 pubname_entry e;
10798 e.name = NULL;
10799 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10800 || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
10801 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
10803 e.die = die;
10804 if (TYPE_P (decl))
10806 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
10808 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
10809 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl));
10810 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
10811 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
10812 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
10813 else
10814 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
10817 else
10819 e.name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
10820 if (e.name)
10821 e.name = xstrdup (e.name);
10824 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
10825 it to the table. */
10826 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
10827 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
10831 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
10832 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
10834 static void
10835 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
10837 unsigned i;
10838 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
10839 pubname_ref pub;
10841 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10842 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10843 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10844 if (names == pubname_table)
10845 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
10846 "Length of Public Names Info");
10847 else
10848 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
10849 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
10850 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
10851 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10852 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10853 debug_info_section,
10854 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10855 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
10856 "Compilation Unit Length");
10858 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
10860 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
10861 if (names == pubname_table)
10862 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
10864 if (names != pubtype_table
10865 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
10866 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
10868 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
10869 "DIE offset");
10871 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
10875 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10878 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
10880 static void
10881 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10883 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10884 return;
10886 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
10888 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10889 arange_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, arange_table,
10890 arange_table_allocated);
10891 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
10892 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
10895 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
10898 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
10899 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
10900 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
10902 static void
10903 output_aranges (void)
10905 unsigned i;
10906 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
10908 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10909 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10910 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10911 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
10912 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
10913 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
10914 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10915 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10916 debug_info_section,
10917 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10918 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
10919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
10921 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
10922 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
10924 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
10925 pointer size. */
10926 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
10927 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10928 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
10929 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
10932 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
10933 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
10934 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
10935 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
10936 confused with the terminator. */
10937 if (text_section_used)
10939 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
10940 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
10941 text_section_label, "Length");
10943 if (cold_text_section_used)
10945 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
10946 "Address");
10947 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
10948 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
10951 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
10953 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
10955 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
10956 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
10958 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
10960 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
10961 "Address");
10962 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
10963 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
10965 else
10967 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
10968 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
10969 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
10970 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
10971 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10973 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
10975 loc = AT_loc (a);
10976 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
10978 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10979 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
10980 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10981 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
10982 "Length");
10986 /* Output the terminator words. */
10987 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10988 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10991 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
10992 was placed. */
10994 static unsigned int
10995 add_ranges_num (int num)
10997 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
10999 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
11001 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11002 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_struct, ranges_table,
11003 ranges_table_allocated);
11004 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
11005 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
11008 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
11009 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
11011 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11014 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11015 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
11017 static unsigned int
11018 add_ranges (const_tree block)
11020 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
11023 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
11024 labels. */
11026 static unsigned int
11027 add_ranges_by_labels (const char *begin, const char *end)
11029 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
11031 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
11033 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11034 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct,
11035 ranges_by_label,
11036 ranges_by_label_allocated);
11037 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
11038 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
11039 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
11042 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
11043 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
11044 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
11046 return add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
11049 static void
11050 output_ranges (void)
11052 unsigned i;
11053 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
11054 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11056 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
11058 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
11060 if (block_num > 0)
11062 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11063 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11065 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11066 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11068 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11069 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11070 base of the text section. */
11071 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11073 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11074 text_section_label,
11075 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11076 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11077 text_section_label, NULL);
11080 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11081 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11082 about whether the target supports cross-section
11083 arithmetic. */
11084 else
11086 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11087 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11088 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11091 fmt = NULL;
11094 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11095 else if (block_num < 0)
11097 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11099 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11101 gcc_unreachable ();
11102 #if 0
11103 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11104 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11105 the #if 0 above. */
11106 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11107 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11108 text_section_label,
11109 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11110 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11111 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11112 text_section_label, NULL);
11113 #endif
11115 else
11117 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11118 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11119 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11120 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11121 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11122 NULL);
11125 else
11127 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11128 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11129 fmt = start_fmt;
11134 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11135 struct file_info
11137 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11138 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11139 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11140 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11141 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11144 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11145 files. */
11146 struct dir_info
11148 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11149 int length; /* Path length. */
11150 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11151 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11152 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11155 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11156 the directories in the path. */
11158 static int
11159 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11161 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11162 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11163 const unsigned char *cp1;
11164 const unsigned char *cp2;
11166 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
11167 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
11168 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
11169 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
11170 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
11171 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
11172 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
11174 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
11175 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
11177 while (1)
11179 ++cp1;
11180 ++cp2;
11181 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
11182 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
11183 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
11184 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
11185 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
11187 /* Character of current path component the same? */
11188 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
11189 return *cp1 - *cp2;
11193 struct file_name_acquire_data
11195 struct file_info *files;
11196 int used_files;
11197 int max_files;
11200 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
11202 static int
11203 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
11205 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = (struct file_name_acquire_data *) data;
11206 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
11207 struct file_info *fi;
11208 const char *f;
11210 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
11212 if (! d->emitted_number)
11213 return 1;
11215 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
11217 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
11219 /* Skip all leading "./". */
11220 f = d->filename;
11221 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
11222 f += 2;
11224 /* Create a new array entry. */
11225 fi->path = f;
11226 fi->length = strlen (f);
11227 fi->file_idx = d;
11229 /* Search for the file name part. */
11230 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
11231 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
11233 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
11235 if (g != NULL)
11237 if (f == NULL || f < g)
11238 f = g;
11241 #endif
11243 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
11244 return 1;
11247 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
11248 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
11249 slowdowns with many input files. */
11251 static void
11252 output_file_names (void)
11254 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
11255 int numfiles;
11256 struct file_info *files;
11257 struct dir_info *dirs;
11258 int *saved;
11259 int *savehere;
11260 int *backmap;
11261 int ndirs;
11262 int idx_offset;
11263 int i;
11264 int idx;
11266 if (!last_emitted_file)
11268 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11269 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11270 return;
11273 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
11275 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
11276 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
11277 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
11279 fnad.files = files;
11280 fnad.used_files = 0;
11281 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
11282 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
11283 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
11285 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
11287 /* Find all the different directories used. */
11288 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
11289 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
11290 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
11291 dirs[0].count = 1;
11292 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
11293 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
11294 ndirs = 1;
11296 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
11297 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
11298 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
11299 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
11301 /* Same directory as last entry. */
11302 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
11303 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
11305 else
11307 int j;
11309 /* This is a new directory. */
11310 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
11311 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
11312 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
11313 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
11314 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
11316 /* Search for a prefix. */
11317 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
11318 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
11319 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
11320 && dirs[j].length > 1
11321 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
11322 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
11323 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
11324 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
11326 ++ndirs;
11329 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
11330 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
11331 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
11332 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
11333 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
11334 results in most cases and never is much off. */
11335 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11336 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11338 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
11339 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
11341 int j;
11342 int total;
11344 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
11345 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
11346 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
11347 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
11349 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
11351 savehere[j] = 0;
11352 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
11354 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
11355 dirs[j] path. */
11356 int k;
11358 k = dirs[j].prefix;
11359 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
11360 k = dirs[k].prefix;
11362 if (k == (int) i)
11364 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
11365 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
11366 dirs[i]. */
11367 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
11368 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
11373 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
11374 directory. */
11375 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
11377 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
11378 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
11379 if (savehere[j] > 0)
11381 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
11382 saved[j] = savehere[j];
11384 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
11385 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
11390 /* Emit the directory name table. */
11391 idx = 1;
11392 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
11393 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11394 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11395 dirs[i].length
11396 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11397 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
11399 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11401 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
11402 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
11403 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
11404 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
11405 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11406 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
11408 /* Now write all the file names. */
11409 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11411 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11412 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11414 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11415 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
11417 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
11418 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
11420 int ver;
11421 long long cdt;
11422 long siz;
11423 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
11424 + dirs[dir_idx].length
11425 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
11426 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
11428 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
11429 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
11430 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
11432 dw2_asm_output_nstring
11433 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
11435 /* Include directory index. */
11436 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11438 /* Modification time. */
11439 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
11440 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
11441 ? cdt : 0,
11442 NULL);
11444 /* File length in bytes. */
11445 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
11446 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
11447 ? siz : 0,
11448 NULL);
11449 #else
11450 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
11451 "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
11453 /* Include directory index. */
11454 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11456 /* Modification time. */
11457 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11459 /* File length in bytes. */
11460 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11461 #endif
11464 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11468 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
11469 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
11471 static void
11472 output_line_info (void)
11474 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
11475 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11476 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11477 unsigned opc;
11478 unsigned n_op_args;
11479 unsigned long lt_index;
11480 unsigned long current_line;
11481 long line_offset;
11482 long line_delta;
11483 unsigned long current_file;
11484 unsigned long function;
11485 int ver = dwarf_version;
11487 /* Don't mark the output as DWARF-4 until we make full use of the
11488 version 4 extensions, and gdb supports them. For now, -gdwarf-4
11489 selects only a few extensions from the DWARF-4 spec. */
11490 if (ver > 3)
11491 ver = 3;
11493 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
11494 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
11495 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
11496 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
11498 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11499 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11500 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11501 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11502 "Length of Source Line Info");
11503 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11505 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
11506 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
11507 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
11509 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
11510 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
11511 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
11512 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
11513 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
11514 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
11515 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
11516 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
11517 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
11518 "Minimum Instruction Length");
11520 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
11521 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
11522 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
11523 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
11524 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
11525 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
11526 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
11527 "Special Opcode Base");
11529 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
11531 switch (opc)
11533 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
11534 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
11535 case DW_LNS_set_file:
11536 case DW_LNS_set_column:
11537 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
11538 n_op_args = 1;
11539 break;
11540 default:
11541 n_op_args = 0;
11542 break;
11545 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
11546 opc, n_op_args);
11549 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
11550 output_file_names ();
11551 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
11553 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
11554 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
11555 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
11557 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
11558 a series of state machine operations. */
11559 current_file = 1;
11560 current_line = 1;
11562 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
11563 strcpy (prev_line_label, crtl->subsections.cold_section_label);
11564 else
11565 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
11566 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
11568 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
11570 #if 0
11571 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
11572 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
11573 prologue. */
11575 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
11576 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
11577 that anything after the last address is this line. */
11578 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
11579 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
11580 continue;
11581 #endif
11583 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
11585 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
11586 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
11587 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
11588 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
11589 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
11590 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
11592 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
11593 if (0)
11595 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
11596 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11597 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11598 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11600 else
11602 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
11603 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
11604 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11605 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11606 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11607 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11610 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
11612 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
11613 different from the previous line. */
11614 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
11616 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
11617 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
11618 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
11621 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
11622 that uses the least amount of space. */
11623 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
11625 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
11626 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
11627 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
11628 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
11629 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
11630 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
11631 takes 1 byte. */
11632 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
11633 "line %lu", current_line);
11634 else
11636 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
11637 depending on the value being encoded. */
11638 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
11639 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
11640 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
11641 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11644 else
11645 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
11646 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11649 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
11650 if (0)
11652 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11653 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11654 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11656 else
11658 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11659 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11660 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11661 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
11664 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
11665 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
11666 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
11668 function = 0;
11669 current_file = 1;
11670 current_line = 1;
11671 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
11673 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
11674 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
11676 #if 0
11677 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
11678 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
11679 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
11680 && line_info->function == function)
11681 goto cont;
11682 #endif
11684 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
11685 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
11686 to handle it differently. */
11687 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
11688 lt_index);
11689 if (function != line_info->function)
11691 function = line_info->function;
11693 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
11694 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11695 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11696 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11697 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11699 else
11701 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
11702 if (0)
11704 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11705 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11706 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11708 else
11710 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11711 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11712 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11713 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11717 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
11719 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
11720 different from the previous line. */
11721 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
11723 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
11724 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
11725 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
11728 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
11729 that uses the least amount of space. */
11730 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
11732 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
11733 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
11734 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
11735 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
11736 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
11737 "line %lu", current_line);
11738 else
11740 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
11741 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
11742 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
11743 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11746 else
11747 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11749 #if 0
11750 cont:
11751 #endif
11753 lt_index++;
11755 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
11756 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
11757 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
11759 current_file = 1;
11760 current_line = 1;
11762 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
11763 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
11764 if (0)
11766 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11767 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11768 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11770 else
11772 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11773 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11774 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11775 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11778 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
11779 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
11780 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
11781 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
11785 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
11786 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
11789 /* Return the size of the .debug_dcall table for the compilation unit. */
11791 static unsigned long
11792 size_of_dcall_table (void)
11794 unsigned long size;
11795 unsigned int i;
11796 dcall_entry *p;
11797 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
11799 /* Header: version + debug info section pointer + pointer size. */
11800 size = 2 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
11802 /* Each entry: code label + DIE offset. */
11803 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p); i++)
11805 gcc_assert (p->targ_die != NULL);
11806 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
11807 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
11809 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
11810 gcc_assert (poc_die);
11811 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
11812 if (poc_die)
11813 size += (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
11814 + size_of_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset));
11816 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset);
11819 return size;
11822 /* Output the direct call table used to disambiguate PC values when
11823 identical function have been merged. */
11825 static void
11826 output_dcall_table (void)
11828 unsigned i;
11829 unsigned long dcall_length = size_of_dcall_table ();
11830 dcall_entry *p;
11831 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11832 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
11834 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11835 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11836 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11837 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, dcall_length,
11838 "Length of Direct Call Table");
11839 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
11840 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11841 debug_info_section,
11842 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11843 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11845 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p); i++)
11847 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
11848 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
11850 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
11851 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
11852 if (poc_die)
11854 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, "New caller");
11855 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset,
11856 "Caller DIE offset");
11859 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
11860 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
11861 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset,
11862 "Callee DIE offset");
11866 /* Return the size of the .debug_vcall table for the compilation unit. */
11868 static unsigned long
11869 size_of_vcall_table (void)
11871 unsigned long size;
11872 unsigned int i;
11873 vcall_entry *p;
11875 /* Header: version + pointer size. */
11876 size = 2 + 1;
11878 /* Each entry: code label + vtable slot index. */
11879 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p); i++)
11880 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot);
11882 return size;
11885 /* Output the virtual call table used to disambiguate PC values when
11886 identical function have been merged. */
11888 static void
11889 output_vcall_table (void)
11891 unsigned i;
11892 unsigned long vcall_length = size_of_vcall_table ();
11893 vcall_entry *p;
11894 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11896 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11897 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11898 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11899 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, vcall_length,
11900 "Length of Virtual Call Table");
11901 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
11902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11904 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p); i++)
11906 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
11907 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
11908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot, "Vtable slot");
11912 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
11913 a DIE that describes the given type.
11915 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
11916 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
11918 static dw_die_ref
11919 base_type_die (tree type)
11921 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
11922 enum dwarf_type encoding;
11924 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
11925 return 0;
11927 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
11928 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
11929 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
11930 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11932 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11934 case INTEGER_TYPE:
11935 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
11937 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11938 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
11939 else
11940 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
11942 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11943 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
11944 else
11945 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
11946 break;
11948 case REAL_TYPE:
11949 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
11951 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
11952 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
11953 else
11954 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
11956 else
11957 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
11958 break;
11960 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
11961 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
11962 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
11963 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11964 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
11965 else
11966 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
11967 break;
11969 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
11970 a user defined type for it. */
11971 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
11972 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
11973 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
11974 else
11975 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
11976 break;
11978 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
11979 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
11980 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
11981 break;
11983 default:
11984 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
11985 gcc_unreachable ();
11988 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
11990 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
11991 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
11992 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
11994 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
11995 int_size_in_bytes (type));
11996 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
11998 return base_type_result;
12001 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12002 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12004 static inline int
12005 is_base_type (tree type)
12007 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12009 case ERROR_MARK:
12010 case VOID_TYPE:
12011 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12012 case REAL_TYPE:
12013 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12014 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12015 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12016 return 1;
12018 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12019 case RECORD_TYPE:
12020 case UNION_TYPE:
12021 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12022 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12023 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12024 case METHOD_TYPE:
12025 case POINTER_TYPE:
12026 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12027 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12028 case LANG_TYPE:
12029 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12030 return 0;
12032 default:
12033 gcc_unreachable ();
12036 return 0;
12039 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12040 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12041 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12042 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12043 ERROR_MARK node. */
12045 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12046 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12048 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12049 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12050 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12051 return 0;
12052 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
12053 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
12054 else
12055 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12058 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12059 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12061 static dw_die_ref
12062 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, dw_die_ref context_die)
12064 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12065 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12067 if (context_die == NULL)
12068 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12070 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12072 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12074 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12075 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12076 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12079 if (low)
12080 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low);
12081 if (high)
12082 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high);
12084 return subrange_die;
12087 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12088 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
12090 static dw_die_ref
12091 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
12092 dw_die_ref context_die)
12094 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12095 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12096 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12097 tree item_type = NULL;
12098 tree qualified_type;
12099 tree name, low, high;
12101 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12102 return NULL;
12104 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12105 this type. */
12106 qualified_type
12107 = get_qualified_type (type,
12108 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
12109 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
12111 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12112 if (qualified_type)
12114 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12115 if (mod_type_die)
12116 return mod_type_die;
12119 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12121 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12122 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
12124 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12126 if (qualified_type == dtype)
12128 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12129 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12130 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12132 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12133 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12134 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12135 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12136 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12137 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
12138 type to which it refers. */
12139 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
12140 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
12141 context_die);
12142 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
12145 if (is_const_type)
12147 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12148 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
12150 else if (is_volatile_type)
12152 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12153 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
12155 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
12157 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12158 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12159 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12160 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12161 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12162 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12163 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12165 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12167 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12168 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12169 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12170 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12171 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12172 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12173 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12175 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
12176 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
12177 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
12179 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, context_die);
12180 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12182 else if (is_base_type (type))
12183 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
12184 else
12186 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12188 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
12189 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
12190 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
12191 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
12192 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
12193 ..._TYPE node. */
12194 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12195 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
12196 else
12197 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
12198 not the main variant. */
12199 return lookup_type_die (type);
12202 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
12203 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
12204 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
12205 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
12206 if the base type already has the same name. */
12207 if (name
12208 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
12209 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
12210 || (!is_const_type && !is_volatile_type)))
12211 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12212 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
12213 && DECL_NAME (name))))
12215 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
12216 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
12217 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
12218 useful source coordinates anyway. */
12219 name = DECL_NAME (name);
12220 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
12223 if (qualified_type)
12224 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
12226 if (item_type)
12227 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
12228 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
12229 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
12230 types are possible in Ada. */
12231 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
12232 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
12233 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
12234 context_die);
12236 if (sub_die != NULL)
12237 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
12239 return mod_type_die;
12242 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
12243 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
12244 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
12246 static void
12247 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
12249 tree parms, args;
12250 int parms_num, i;
12251 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
12253 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
12254 return;
12256 if (TYPE_P (t))
12257 die = lookup_type_die (t);
12258 else if (DECL_P (t))
12259 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
12261 gcc_assert (die);
12263 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
12264 if (!parms)
12265 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
12266 or function. End of story. */
12267 return;
12269 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
12270 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
12271 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
12273 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
12275 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
12276 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
12277 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
12278 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
12280 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
12282 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
12283 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
12284 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
12285 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
12286 an argument pack. */
12287 if (arg_pack_elems)
12288 template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
12289 arg_pack_elems,
12290 die);
12291 else
12292 generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
12293 true /* Emit DW_AT_name */, die);
12298 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
12299 the representation of a generic type parameter.
12300 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
12301 ARG is the argument to PARM.
12302 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
12303 name of the PARM.
12304 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
12305 as a child node. */
12307 static dw_die_ref
12308 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
12309 bool emit_name_p,
12310 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12312 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
12313 const char *name = NULL;
12315 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
12316 return NULL;
12318 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
12319 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
12320 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
12321 and arguments. */
12322 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12323 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
12324 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
12325 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
12326 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
12327 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
12328 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12329 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
12330 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
12331 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
12332 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
12333 name of the template template argument. */
12334 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
12335 parent_die, parm);
12336 else
12337 gcc_unreachable ();
12339 if (tmpl_die)
12341 tree tmpl_type;
12343 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
12344 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
12345 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
12346 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
12347 the die. */
12348 if (emit_name_p)
12350 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
12351 gcc_assert (name);
12352 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
12355 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12357 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
12358 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
12359 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
12360 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
12361 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
12362 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
12363 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type, 0,
12364 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type),
12365 parent_die);
12367 else
12369 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
12370 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
12371 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
12373 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
12374 to the name of the argument. */
12375 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
12376 if (name)
12377 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
12380 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12381 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
12382 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
12383 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
12384 of ARG.
12385 We must be careful here:
12386 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
12387 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
12388 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
12389 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
12390 emitted after cgraph computations.
12391 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
12392 after cgraph is ready. */
12393 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
12396 return tmpl_die;
12399 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
12400 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
12401 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
12403 static dw_die_ref
12404 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
12405 tree parm_pack_args,
12406 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12408 dw_die_ref die;
12409 int j;
12411 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
12413 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
12414 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
12415 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
12416 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
12417 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
12418 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
12419 die);
12420 return die;
12423 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
12424 an enumerated type. */
12426 static inline int
12427 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
12429 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
12432 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
12434 static unsigned int
12435 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
12437 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
12439 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
12441 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
12442 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
12444 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
12445 if (leaf_reg != -1)
12446 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
12448 #endif
12450 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
12453 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
12454 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
12455 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
12457 static void
12458 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
12460 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
12462 if (*list_head != NULL)
12464 /* Find the end of the chain. */
12465 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
12468 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
12469 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
12473 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
12474 zero if there is none. */
12476 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12477 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
12479 rtx regs;
12481 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12482 return 0;
12484 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
12486 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
12487 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
12488 else
12489 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl), initialized);
12492 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
12493 a given hard register number. */
12495 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12496 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
12498 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
12500 if (regno <= 31)
12501 reg_loc_descr
12502 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
12503 else
12504 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
12506 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12507 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12509 return reg_loc_descr;
12512 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
12513 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
12515 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12516 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
12517 enum var_init_status initialized)
12519 int nregs, size, i;
12520 unsigned reg;
12521 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
12523 reg = REGNO (rtl);
12524 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
12525 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
12527 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
12528 if (leaf_reg != -1)
12529 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
12531 #endif
12532 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
12533 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
12535 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
12536 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
12538 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
12540 loc_result = NULL;
12541 while (nregs--)
12543 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
12545 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
12546 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12547 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
12548 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
12549 ++reg;
12551 return loc_result;
12554 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
12556 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
12558 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
12559 loc_result = NULL;
12561 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
12563 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
12565 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
12566 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12567 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
12568 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
12569 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
12572 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12573 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12574 return loc_result;
12577 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
12579 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
12581 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
12583 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12584 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12586 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12588 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
12589 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
12590 if (i >= 0)
12592 if (i <= 31)
12593 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
12594 else if (i <= 0xff)
12595 op = DW_OP_const1u;
12596 else if (i <= 0xffff)
12597 op = DW_OP_const2u;
12598 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12599 || i <= 0xffffffff)
12600 op = DW_OP_const4u;
12601 else
12602 op = DW_OP_constu;
12604 else
12606 if (i >= -0x80)
12607 op = DW_OP_const1s;
12608 else if (i >= -0x8000)
12609 op = DW_OP_const2s;
12610 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12611 || i >= -0x80000000)
12612 op = DW_OP_const4s;
12613 else
12614 op = DW_OP_consts;
12617 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
12619 #endif
12621 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
12622 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
12623 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
12625 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12626 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12628 int litsize;
12629 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
12631 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12632 return NULL;
12634 if (i >= 0)
12636 if (i <= 31)
12637 litsize = 1;
12638 else if (i <= 0xff)
12639 litsize = 2;
12640 else if (i <= 0xffff)
12641 litsize = 3;
12642 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12643 || i <= 0xffffffff)
12644 litsize = 5;
12645 else
12646 litsize = 1 + size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
12648 else
12650 if (i >= -0x80)
12651 litsize = 2;
12652 else if (i >= -0x8000)
12653 litsize = 3;
12654 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12655 || i >= -0x80000000)
12656 litsize = 5;
12657 else
12658 litsize = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
12660 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
12661 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
12662 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
12663 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
12664 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
12665 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
12667 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
12668 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
12669 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12670 return loc_result;
12673 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
12674 size, 0);
12675 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
12676 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
12677 return loc_result;
12680 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
12682 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12683 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
12684 enum var_init_status initialized)
12686 unsigned int regno;
12687 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
12688 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
12690 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
12691 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
12692 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
12693 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
12694 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12696 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
12698 if (elim != reg)
12700 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
12702 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
12703 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
12705 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
12706 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12707 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
12708 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
12709 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12710 : stack_pointer_rtx));
12712 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
12713 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
12714 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
12715 access stack variables. */
12716 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
12717 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12719 int base_reg
12720 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
12721 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12722 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
12723 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
12726 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
12727 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12730 else if (fde
12731 && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM
12732 && (fde->drap_reg == REGNO (reg)
12733 || fde->vdrap_reg == REGNO (reg)))
12735 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
12736 on stack when drap is used to align stack. */
12737 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12740 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
12741 if (regno <= 31)
12742 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
12743 offset, 0);
12744 else
12745 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
12747 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12748 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12750 return result;
12753 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
12755 static inline int
12756 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
12758 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
12759 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12760 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12761 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
12764 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
12765 failed. */
12767 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12768 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
12770 tree base;
12771 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
12773 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || MEM_OFFSET (mem) == NULL_RTX)
12774 return NULL;
12776 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
12777 if (base == NULL
12778 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
12779 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
12780 return NULL;
12782 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1);
12783 if (loc_result == NULL)
12784 return NULL;
12786 if (INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)))
12787 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)));
12789 return loc_result;
12792 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
12793 expression. */
12795 static void
12796 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
12798 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
12800 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
12801 if (expr)
12802 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
12803 if (rtl)
12805 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
12806 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
12808 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
12812 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output, called either directly
12813 or via for_each_rtx. */
12815 static int
12816 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx *rtlp, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12818 rtx rtl = *rtlp;
12820 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
12821 return 0;
12823 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
12825 bool marked;
12826 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
12827 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
12828 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
12829 if (!marked)
12831 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12832 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
12833 return 1;
12837 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
12838 return 1;
12840 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
12841 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
12842 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
12843 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
12844 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
12845 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
12847 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
12849 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
12851 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12852 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
12853 return 1;
12857 return 0;
12860 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
12861 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
12862 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
12864 static bool
12865 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
12867 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
12868 return const_ok_for_output_1 (&rtl, NULL) == 0;
12870 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
12871 return for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), const_ok_for_output_1, NULL) == 0;
12873 return true;
12876 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
12877 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
12878 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
12879 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
12881 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
12882 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
12883 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
12884 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
12886 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
12887 autoincrement addressing modes.
12889 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
12890 location list for RTL.
12892 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
12894 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12895 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
12896 enum var_init_status initialized)
12898 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
12899 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12900 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
12902 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
12903 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
12904 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
12905 zeroth element of the array. */
12907 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
12909 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
12911 case POST_INC:
12912 case POST_DEC:
12913 case POST_MODIFY:
12914 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
12916 case SUBREG:
12917 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
12918 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
12919 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
12920 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
12921 contains the given subreg. */
12922 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
12923 break;
12924 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
12925 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12926 break;
12927 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (rtl)) != MODE_INT)
12928 break;
12929 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, initialized);
12930 break;
12932 case REG:
12933 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
12934 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
12935 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
12936 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
12937 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
12938 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
12939 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
12940 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
12941 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
12942 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
12943 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
12944 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
12945 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
12946 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12947 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12948 else if (stack_realign_drap
12949 && crtl->drap_reg
12950 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
12951 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12953 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
12954 out, use DRAP instead. */
12955 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
12956 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12958 break;
12960 case SIGN_EXTEND:
12961 case ZERO_EXTEND:
12962 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
12963 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12964 if (op0 == 0)
12965 break;
12966 else
12968 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12969 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
12970 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
12971 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
12972 op = DW_OP_shra;
12973 else
12974 op = DW_OP_shr;
12975 mem_loc_result = op0;
12976 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12977 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12978 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12979 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12981 break;
12983 case MEM:
12984 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
12985 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12986 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
12987 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
12988 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
12989 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
12990 break;
12992 case LO_SUM:
12993 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
12995 /* ... fall through ... */
12997 case LABEL_REF:
12998 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
12999 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
13000 pool. */
13001 case CONST:
13002 case SYMBOL_REF:
13003 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
13004 by a different symbol. */
13005 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13007 bool marked;
13008 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13010 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
13012 rtl = tmp;
13013 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
13014 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
13015 else
13016 marked = true;
13019 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13020 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
13021 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
13022 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
13023 if (!marked)
13025 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13026 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13027 return 0;
13031 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
13032 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13034 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13036 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
13037 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
13038 break;
13040 temp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
13041 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13042 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13043 temp->dtprel = true;
13045 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
13046 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
13048 break;
13051 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13052 break;
13054 symref:
13055 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
13056 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13057 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13058 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
13059 break;
13061 case CONCAT:
13062 case CONCATN:
13063 case VAR_LOCATION:
13064 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13065 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
13066 return 0;
13068 case PRE_MODIFY:
13069 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
13070 PLUS code below. */
13071 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13072 goto plus;
13074 case PRE_INC:
13075 case PRE_DEC:
13076 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
13077 below. */
13078 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
13079 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
13080 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
13081 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
13083 /* ... fall through ... */
13085 case PLUS:
13086 plus:
13087 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
13088 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13089 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
13090 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13091 else
13093 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13094 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13095 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
13096 break;
13098 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13099 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13100 else
13102 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result2
13103 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13104 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13105 if (mem_loc_result2 == 0)
13106 break;
13107 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, mem_loc_result2);
13108 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13109 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13112 break;
13114 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
13115 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
13116 case MINUS:
13117 op = DW_OP_minus;
13118 goto do_binop;
13120 case MULT:
13121 op = DW_OP_mul;
13122 goto do_binop;
13124 case DIV:
13125 op = DW_OP_div;
13126 goto do_binop;
13128 case MOD:
13129 op = DW_OP_mod;
13130 goto do_binop;
13132 case ASHIFT:
13133 op = DW_OP_shl;
13134 goto do_binop;
13136 case ASHIFTRT:
13137 op = DW_OP_shra;
13138 goto do_binop;
13140 case LSHIFTRT:
13141 op = DW_OP_shr;
13142 goto do_binop;
13144 case AND:
13145 op = DW_OP_and;
13146 goto do_binop;
13148 case IOR:
13149 op = DW_OP_or;
13150 goto do_binop;
13152 case XOR:
13153 op = DW_OP_xor;
13154 goto do_binop;
13156 do_binop:
13157 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13158 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13159 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13160 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13162 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13163 break;
13165 mem_loc_result = op0;
13166 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13167 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13168 break;
13170 case NOT:
13171 op = DW_OP_not;
13172 goto do_unop;
13174 case ABS:
13175 op = DW_OP_abs;
13176 goto do_unop;
13178 case NEG:
13179 op = DW_OP_neg;
13180 goto do_unop;
13182 do_unop:
13183 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13184 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13186 if (op0 == 0)
13187 break;
13189 mem_loc_result = op0;
13190 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13191 break;
13193 case CONST_INT:
13194 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13195 break;
13197 case EQ:
13198 op = DW_OP_eq;
13199 goto do_scompare;
13201 case GE:
13202 op = DW_OP_ge;
13203 goto do_scompare;
13205 case GT:
13206 op = DW_OP_gt;
13207 goto do_scompare;
13209 case LE:
13210 op = DW_OP_le;
13211 goto do_scompare;
13213 case LT:
13214 op = DW_OP_lt;
13215 goto do_scompare;
13217 case NE:
13218 op = DW_OP_ne;
13219 goto do_scompare;
13221 do_scompare:
13222 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
13223 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13224 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13225 break;
13227 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13228 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13229 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13230 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13232 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13233 break;
13235 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13237 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13238 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13239 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13240 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13241 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13242 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13243 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
13244 else
13246 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13247 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13251 do_compare:
13252 mem_loc_result = op0;
13253 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13254 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13255 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13257 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13258 int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13259 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13261 break;
13263 case GEU:
13264 op = DW_OP_ge;
13265 goto do_ucompare;
13267 case GTU:
13268 op = DW_OP_gt;
13269 goto do_ucompare;
13271 case LEU:
13272 op = DW_OP_le;
13273 goto do_ucompare;
13275 case LTU:
13276 op = DW_OP_lt;
13277 goto do_ucompare;
13279 do_ucompare:
13280 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
13281 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13282 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13283 break;
13285 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13286 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13287 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13288 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13290 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13291 break;
13293 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13295 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13296 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13297 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13298 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13299 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
13300 else
13302 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13303 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13306 else
13308 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
13309 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
13310 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13311 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13312 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
13313 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13314 else
13315 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13317 goto do_compare;
13319 case SMIN:
13320 case SMAX:
13321 case UMIN:
13322 case UMAX:
13323 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
13324 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13325 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13326 break;
13328 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13329 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13330 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13331 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13333 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13334 break;
13336 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
13337 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13338 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13339 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
13341 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13343 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13344 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13345 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13346 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13347 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13349 else
13351 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
13352 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
13353 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13354 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13357 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13359 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13360 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13361 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13362 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13363 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13364 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13365 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13368 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
13369 op = DW_OP_lt;
13370 else
13371 op = DW_OP_gt;
13372 mem_loc_result = op0;
13373 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13374 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13376 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
13378 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13379 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
13380 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13381 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13382 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
13383 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13384 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
13386 break;
13388 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
13389 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
13390 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13391 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13392 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13393 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13394 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)))
13395 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13396 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13398 int shift, size;
13399 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13400 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13401 if (op0 == 0)
13402 break;
13403 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
13404 op = DW_OP_shra;
13405 else
13406 op = DW_OP_shr;
13407 mem_loc_result = op0;
13408 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13409 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
13410 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
13411 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13412 - shift - size;
13413 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13415 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13416 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13417 - shift - size));
13418 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13420 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13422 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13423 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
13424 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13427 break;
13429 case COMPARE:
13430 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
13431 case ROTATE:
13432 case ROTATERT:
13433 case TRUNCATE:
13434 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
13435 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
13436 natively. */
13437 case SS_MULT:
13438 case US_MULT:
13439 case SS_DIV:
13440 case US_DIV:
13441 case UDIV:
13442 case UMOD:
13443 case UNORDERED:
13444 case ORDERED:
13445 case UNEQ:
13446 case UNGE:
13447 case UNGT:
13448 case UNLE:
13449 case UNLT:
13450 case LTGT:
13451 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
13452 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
13453 case FLOAT:
13454 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
13455 case FIX:
13456 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
13457 case FRACT_CONVERT:
13458 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
13459 case SAT_FRACT:
13460 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
13461 case SQRT:
13462 case BSWAP:
13463 case FFS:
13464 case CLZ:
13465 case CTZ:
13466 case POPCOUNT:
13467 case PARITY:
13468 case ASM_OPERANDS:
13469 case UNSPEC:
13470 case HIGH:
13471 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
13472 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
13473 TLS UNSPECs. */
13474 break;
13476 case CONST_STRING:
13477 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
13478 goto symref;
13480 default:
13481 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
13482 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
13483 gcc_unreachable ();
13484 #else
13485 break;
13486 #endif
13489 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13490 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13492 return mem_loc_result;
13495 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
13496 This is typically a complex variable. */
13498 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13499 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
13501 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
13502 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
13503 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13504 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
13505 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13507 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
13508 return 0;
13510 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
13511 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
13513 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
13514 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
13516 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13517 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13519 return cc_loc_result;
13522 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
13523 locations. */
13525 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13526 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
13528 unsigned int i;
13529 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
13530 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
13532 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
13534 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
13535 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
13537 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13538 if (ref == NULL)
13539 return NULL;
13541 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
13542 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
13545 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13546 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13548 return cc_loc_result;
13551 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
13552 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
13553 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
13554 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
13555 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
13557 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
13558 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
13559 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
13561 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
13563 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13564 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
13565 enum var_init_status initialized)
13567 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13569 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13571 case SUBREG:
13572 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
13573 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
13574 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
13575 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
13576 contains the given subreg. */
13577 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl), mode, initialized);
13578 break;
13580 case REG:
13581 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
13582 break;
13584 case SIGN_EXTEND:
13585 case ZERO_EXTEND:
13586 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
13587 break;
13589 case MEM:
13590 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
13591 initialized);
13592 if (loc_result == NULL)
13593 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
13594 break;
13596 case CONCAT:
13597 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
13598 initialized);
13599 break;
13601 case CONCATN:
13602 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
13603 break;
13605 case VAR_LOCATION:
13606 /* Single part. */
13607 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
13609 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0), mode,
13610 initialized);
13611 break;
13614 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13615 /* FALLTHRU */
13617 case PARALLEL:
13619 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
13620 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
13621 enum machine_mode mode;
13622 int i;
13624 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
13625 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
13626 VOIDmode, initialized);
13627 if (loc_result == NULL)
13628 return NULL;
13629 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
13630 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
13631 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
13633 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13635 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
13636 VOIDmode, initialized);
13637 if (temp == NULL)
13638 return NULL;
13639 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
13640 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
13641 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
13644 break;
13646 case CONST_INT:
13647 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
13648 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
13649 INTVAL (rtl));
13650 break;
13652 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13653 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13655 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
13656 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
13657 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
13658 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
13659 if (GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
13660 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13662 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13663 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
13664 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
13666 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13667 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length);
13669 insert_float (rtl, array);
13670 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13671 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
13672 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
13673 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13675 else
13677 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
13678 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double.high
13679 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl);
13680 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double.low
13681 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl);
13684 break;
13686 case CONST_VECTOR:
13687 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13689 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
13690 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
13691 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length * elt_size);
13692 unsigned int i;
13693 unsigned char *p;
13695 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13696 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
13698 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
13699 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
13701 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
13702 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
13704 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
13706 case CONST_INT:
13707 lo = INTVAL (elt);
13708 hi = -(lo < 0);
13709 break;
13711 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13712 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
13713 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
13714 break;
13716 default:
13717 gcc_unreachable ();
13720 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
13721 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
13722 else
13724 unsigned char *p0 = p;
13725 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13727 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
13728 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
13730 p0 = p1;
13731 p1 = p;
13733 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
13734 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
13737 break;
13739 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
13740 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
13742 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
13743 insert_float (elt, p);
13745 break;
13747 default:
13748 gcc_unreachable ();
13751 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13752 length * elt_size, 0);
13753 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13754 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
13755 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
13756 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13758 break;
13760 case CONST:
13761 if (mode == VOIDmode
13762 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_INT
13763 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_DOUBLE
13764 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
13766 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
13767 break;
13769 /* FALLTHROUGH */
13770 case SYMBOL_REF:
13771 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13772 break;
13773 case LABEL_REF:
13774 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13775 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13777 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13778 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0);
13779 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13780 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr = rtl;
13781 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
13783 break;
13785 default:
13786 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
13787 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13788 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13790 /* Value expression. */
13791 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode, initialized);
13792 if (loc_result)
13793 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13794 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13796 break;
13799 return loc_result;
13802 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
13803 address ranges where a given location is valid.
13804 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
13805 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
13806 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
13807 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
13809 static const char *
13810 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
13812 const char *secname;
13814 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
13816 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
13817 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
13819 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
13821 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
13822 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
13824 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13825 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
13826 else
13827 secname = text_section_label;
13829 return secname;
13832 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
13834 static bool
13835 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
13837 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
13838 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
13839 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
13842 /* Return single element location list containing loc descr REF. */
13844 static dw_loc_list_ref
13845 single_element_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
13847 return new_loc_list (ref, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0);
13850 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
13851 for VARLOC. */
13853 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13854 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
13855 enum var_init_status initialized)
13857 int have_address = 0;
13858 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
13859 enum machine_mode mode;
13861 if (want_address != 2)
13863 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
13864 /* Single part. */
13865 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (varloc, 1)) != PARALLEL)
13867 varloc = XEXP (XEXP (varloc, 1), 0);
13868 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
13869 if (MEM_P (varloc))
13871 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
13872 have_address = 1;
13874 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
13876 else
13877 return 0;
13879 else
13881 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, DECL_MODE (loc), initialized);
13882 have_address = 1;
13885 if (!descr)
13886 return 0;
13888 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
13889 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13891 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13893 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13894 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13895 return 0;
13897 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13898 have_address = 1;
13900 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
13901 if (want_address && !have_address)
13903 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13904 "Want address and only have value");
13905 return 0;
13908 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
13909 if (!want_address && have_address)
13911 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
13912 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13914 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
13916 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13917 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13918 return 0;
13920 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13921 op = DW_OP_deref;
13922 else
13923 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
13925 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
13928 return descr;
13931 /* Return dwarf representation of location list representing for
13932 LOC_LIST of DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in
13933 loc_list_from_tree function. */
13935 static dw_loc_list_ref
13936 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list * loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
13938 const char *endname, *secname;
13939 dw_loc_list_ref list;
13940 rtx varloc;
13941 enum var_init_status initialized;
13942 struct var_loc_node *node;
13943 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
13944 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13946 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
13947 actually construct the list of locations.
13948 The first location information is what is passed to the
13949 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
13950 locations just get added on to that list.
13951 Note that we only know the start address for a location
13952 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
13953 the range [current location start, next location start].
13954 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
13955 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
13957 node = loc_list->first;
13958 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
13960 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note))
13961 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
13962 else
13963 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
13964 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
13965 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
13967 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
13968 list = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
13969 else
13970 return single_element_loc_list (descr);
13971 node = node->next;
13973 if (!node)
13974 return NULL;
13976 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
13977 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
13979 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
13980 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
13981 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
13982 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
13983 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
13984 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, descr,
13985 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
13988 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
13989 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
13990 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
13992 if (!current_function_decl)
13993 endname = text_end_label;
13994 else
13996 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
13997 current_function_funcdef_no);
13998 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
14001 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
14002 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
14003 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
14004 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, descr, node->label, endname, secname);
14006 return list;
14009 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
14010 as location description. */
14012 static bool
14013 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
14015 return (!list->dw_loc_next && !list->begin && !list->end);
14018 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
14020 static void
14021 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
14023 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
14024 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
14025 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14026 while (list)
14028 copy = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_descr_node);
14029 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14030 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
14031 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
14033 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_descr_node);
14034 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14035 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
14036 copy = new_copy;
14038 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14042 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
14043 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
14044 to expression in RET on each possition in program.
14045 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
14047 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
14048 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
14049 and merging them that will need some additional work.
14050 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
14051 structures. */
14053 static void
14054 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
14056 if (!list)
14057 return;
14058 if (!*ret)
14060 *ret = list;
14061 return;
14063 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
14065 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
14066 return;
14068 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
14070 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
14071 *ret = list;
14072 return;
14074 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
14075 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
14076 " location lists.\n");
14077 *ret = NULL;
14078 return;
14081 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
14082 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
14084 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14085 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
14087 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
14088 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
14089 enum machine_mode mode;
14091 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
14093 gcc_assert (!rtl);
14094 return 0;
14096 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
14098 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
14099 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
14100 populated. */
14101 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
14103 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14104 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
14105 return 0;
14107 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14108 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14109 return mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14112 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
14113 by looking for innder INDIRECT_REF expression and turing it
14114 into simple arithmetics. */
14116 static dw_loc_list_ref
14117 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev)
14119 tree obj, offset;
14120 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14121 enum machine_mode mode;
14122 int volatilep;
14123 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14124 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14126 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
14127 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14128 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
14129 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
14130 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
14132 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
14133 return 0;
14135 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
14137 expansion_failed (obj,
14138 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
14139 return 0;
14141 if (!offset && !bitpos)
14142 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1);
14143 else if (toplev
14144 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14145 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14147 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0);
14148 if (!list_ret)
14149 return 0;
14150 if (offset)
14152 /* Variable offset. */
14153 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
14154 if (list_ret1 == 0)
14155 return 0;
14156 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14157 if (!list_ret)
14158 return 0;
14159 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14160 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14162 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14163 if (bytepos > 0)
14164 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14165 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14166 bytepos, 0));
14167 else if (bytepos < 0)
14168 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
14169 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14170 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14172 return list_ret;
14176 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
14177 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
14178 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
14179 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
14180 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
14181 to refer to register values). */
14183 static dw_loc_list_ref
14184 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
14186 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
14187 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14188 int have_address = 0;
14189 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14191 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
14192 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
14193 problem... */
14195 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
14197 case ERROR_MARK:
14198 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
14199 return 0;
14201 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
14202 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
14203 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
14204 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
14205 the names of types. */
14206 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR");
14207 return 0;
14209 case CALL_EXPR:
14210 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
14211 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
14212 return 0;
14214 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
14215 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
14216 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
14217 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
14218 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
14219 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
14220 return 0;
14222 case ADDR_EXPR:
14223 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
14224 e.g. for &this->field. */
14225 if (want_address)
14227 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
14228 (loc, want_address == 2);
14229 if (list_ret)
14230 have_address = 1;
14231 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
14232 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14233 have_address = 1;
14235 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
14236 if (!list_ret && !ret)
14237 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
14238 else
14240 if (want_address)
14241 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
14242 return NULL;
14244 break;
14246 case VAR_DECL:
14247 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
14249 rtx rtl;
14250 enum dwarf_location_atom first_op;
14251 enum dwarf_location_atom second_op;
14252 bool dtprel = false;
14254 if (targetm.have_tls)
14256 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
14257 data. */
14258 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
14259 return 0;
14261 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
14262 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
14263 module. */
14264 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
14265 return 0;
14266 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
14267 dtprel = true;
14268 second_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
14270 else
14272 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
14273 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
14274 return 0;
14275 loc = emutls_decl (loc);
14276 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
14277 second_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
14280 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
14281 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
14282 return 0;
14284 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
14285 return 0;
14286 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14287 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
14288 return 0;
14290 ret = new_loc_descr (first_op, 0, 0);
14291 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14292 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14293 ret->dtprel = dtprel;
14295 ret1 = new_loc_descr (second_op, 0, 0);
14296 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
14298 have_address = 1;
14299 break;
14301 /* FALLTHRU */
14303 case PARM_DECL:
14304 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
14305 return loc_list_from_tree (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
14306 want_address);
14307 /* FALLTHRU */
14309 case RESULT_DECL:
14310 case FUNCTION_DECL:
14312 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
14313 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
14315 if (loc_list && loc_list->first
14316 && (list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address)))
14317 have_address = want_address != 0;
14318 else if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
14320 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
14321 return 0;
14323 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
14325 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
14326 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
14327 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
14328 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
14330 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
14332 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
14333 return 0;
14335 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14337 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
14338 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14339 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14341 else
14343 enum machine_mode mode;
14345 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
14346 if (want_address == 2)
14348 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
14349 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14350 have_address = 1;
14352 else
14354 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14355 if (MEM_P (rtl))
14357 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14358 have_address = 1;
14360 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14362 if (!ret)
14363 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
14364 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
14367 break;
14369 case INDIRECT_REF:
14370 case ALIGN_INDIRECT_REF:
14371 case MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF:
14372 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14373 have_address = 1;
14374 break;
14376 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
14377 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
14379 CASE_CONVERT:
14380 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
14381 case SAVE_EXPR:
14382 case MODIFY_EXPR:
14383 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
14385 case COMPONENT_REF:
14386 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
14387 case ARRAY_REF:
14388 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
14389 case REALPART_EXPR:
14390 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
14392 tree obj, offset;
14393 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14394 enum machine_mode mode;
14395 int volatilep;
14396 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14398 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14399 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
14401 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
14403 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (obj,
14404 want_address == 2
14405 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1);
14406 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
14407 for nonzero bitpos. */
14408 if (list_ret == 0)
14409 return 0;
14410 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
14412 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14413 "bitfield access");
14414 return 0;
14417 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
14419 /* Variable offset. */
14420 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
14421 if (list_ret1 == 0)
14422 return 0;
14423 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14424 if (!list_ret)
14425 return 0;
14426 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14429 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14430 if (bytepos > 0)
14431 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
14432 else if (bytepos < 0)
14433 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
14435 have_address = 1;
14436 break;
14439 case INTEGER_CST:
14440 if ((want_address || !host_integerp (loc, 0))
14441 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14442 have_address = 1;
14443 else if (want_address == 2
14444 && host_integerp (loc, 0)
14445 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
14446 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
14447 tree_low_cst (loc, 0))))
14448 have_address = 1;
14449 else if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
14450 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
14451 else
14453 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14454 "Integer operand is not host integer");
14455 return 0;
14457 break;
14459 case CONSTRUCTOR:
14460 case REAL_CST:
14461 case STRING_CST:
14462 case COMPLEX_CST:
14463 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14464 have_address = 1;
14465 else
14466 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
14467 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14468 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
14469 break;
14471 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
14472 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
14473 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
14474 op = DW_OP_and;
14475 goto do_binop;
14477 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
14478 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
14479 op = DW_OP_xor;
14480 goto do_binop;
14482 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
14483 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
14484 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
14485 op = DW_OP_or;
14486 goto do_binop;
14488 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
14489 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
14490 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
14491 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
14492 op = DW_OP_div;
14493 goto do_binop;
14495 case MINUS_EXPR:
14496 op = DW_OP_minus;
14497 goto do_binop;
14499 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
14500 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
14501 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
14502 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
14503 op = DW_OP_mod;
14504 goto do_binop;
14506 case MULT_EXPR:
14507 op = DW_OP_mul;
14508 goto do_binop;
14510 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
14511 op = DW_OP_shl;
14512 goto do_binop;
14514 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
14515 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
14516 goto do_binop;
14518 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
14519 case PLUS_EXPR:
14520 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
14521 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
14523 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14524 if (list_ret == 0)
14525 return 0;
14527 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0));
14528 break;
14531 op = DW_OP_plus;
14532 goto do_binop;
14534 case LE_EXPR:
14535 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14536 return 0;
14538 op = DW_OP_le;
14539 goto do_binop;
14541 case GE_EXPR:
14542 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14543 return 0;
14545 op = DW_OP_ge;
14546 goto do_binop;
14548 case LT_EXPR:
14549 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14550 return 0;
14552 op = DW_OP_lt;
14553 goto do_binop;
14555 case GT_EXPR:
14556 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14557 return 0;
14559 op = DW_OP_gt;
14560 goto do_binop;
14562 case EQ_EXPR:
14563 op = DW_OP_eq;
14564 goto do_binop;
14566 case NE_EXPR:
14567 op = DW_OP_ne;
14568 goto do_binop;
14570 do_binop:
14571 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14572 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
14573 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
14574 return 0;
14576 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14577 if (list_ret == 0)
14578 return 0;
14579 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14580 break;
14582 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
14583 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
14584 op = DW_OP_not;
14585 goto do_unop;
14587 case ABS_EXPR:
14588 op = DW_OP_abs;
14589 goto do_unop;
14591 case NEGATE_EXPR:
14592 op = DW_OP_neg;
14593 goto do_unop;
14595 do_unop:
14596 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14597 if (list_ret == 0)
14598 return 0;
14600 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14601 break;
14603 case MIN_EXPR:
14604 case MAX_EXPR:
14606 const enum tree_code code =
14607 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
14609 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
14610 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
14611 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
14612 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
14615 /* ... fall through ... */
14617 case COND_EXPR:
14619 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
14620 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
14621 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
14622 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
14623 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
14625 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14626 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
14627 return 0;
14629 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14630 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
14632 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
14633 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14634 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
14636 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
14637 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14638 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
14640 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
14641 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14642 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
14643 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14644 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
14646 break;
14648 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
14649 return 0;
14651 default:
14652 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
14653 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
14654 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
14655 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
14657 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14658 "language specific tree node");
14659 return 0;
14662 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
14663 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
14664 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
14665 gcc_unreachable ();
14666 #else
14667 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
14668 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
14669 return NULL;
14670 #endif
14673 if (!ret && !list_ret)
14674 return 0;
14676 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
14677 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14679 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14681 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14682 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14683 return 0;
14685 if (ret)
14686 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14687 else
14688 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14689 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14690 have_address = 1;
14692 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
14693 if (want_address && !have_address)
14695 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14696 "Want address and only have value");
14697 return 0;
14700 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
14702 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
14703 if (!want_address && have_address)
14705 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14707 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
14709 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14710 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14711 return 0;
14713 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14714 op = DW_OP_deref;
14715 else
14716 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
14718 if (ret)
14719 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14720 else
14721 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14723 if (ret)
14724 list_ret = single_element_loc_list (ret);
14726 return list_ret;
14729 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
14730 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14731 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
14733 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address);
14734 if (!ret)
14735 return NULL;
14736 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
14738 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14739 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
14740 return NULL;
14742 return ret->expr;
14745 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
14746 which is not less than the value itself. */
14748 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
14749 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
14751 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
14754 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
14755 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
14756 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
14757 ERROR_MARK node. */
14759 static inline tree
14760 field_type (const_tree decl)
14762 tree type;
14764 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
14765 return integer_type_node;
14767 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
14768 if (type == NULL_TREE)
14769 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
14771 return type;
14774 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
14775 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
14776 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
14778 static inline unsigned
14779 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
14781 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
14784 static inline unsigned
14785 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
14787 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
14790 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
14792 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
14793 round_up_to_align (HOST_WIDE_INT t, unsigned int align)
14795 /* We must be careful if T is negative because HOST_WIDE_INT can be
14796 either "above" or "below" unsigned int as per the C promotion
14797 rules, depending on the host, thus making the signedness of the
14798 direct multiplication and division unpredictable. */
14799 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT u = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) t;
14801 u += align - 1;
14802 u /= align;
14803 u *= align;
14805 return (HOST_WIDE_INT) u;
14808 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
14809 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
14810 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
14811 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
14812 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
14813 just yet). */
14815 static HOST_WIDE_INT
14816 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
14818 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
14819 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
14821 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
14822 return 0;
14824 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
14826 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
14827 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
14828 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
14829 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
14830 return 0;
14832 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
14834 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
14835 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
14837 tree type;
14838 tree field_size_tree;
14839 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
14840 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
14841 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
14842 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
14843 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
14845 type = field_type (decl);
14846 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
14847 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
14849 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
14851 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
14852 a flexible array member. */
14853 if (!field_size_tree)
14854 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
14856 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
14857 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
14858 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
14859 else
14860 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
14862 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
14864 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
14865 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
14866 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
14867 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
14868 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
14869 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
14870 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
14871 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
14872 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
14874 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
14876 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
14877 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
14878 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
14879 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
14880 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
14881 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
14882 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
14883 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
14884 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
14885 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
14886 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
14888 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
14889 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
14890 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
14891 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
14892 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
14893 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
14894 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
14895 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
14896 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
14897 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
14898 structure type.)
14900 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
14901 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
14902 must have believed that the containing object started (within
14903 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
14904 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
14905 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
14906 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
14908 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
14909 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
14910 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
14912 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
14913 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
14914 be. */
14915 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
14917 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
14918 bitfields. */
14919 object_offset_in_bits
14920 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
14922 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
14924 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
14926 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
14927 object_offset_in_bits
14928 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
14931 else
14932 #endif
14933 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
14935 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14938 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
14939 associated with them. */
14941 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
14943 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
14944 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
14945 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
14947 static inline void
14948 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
14949 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
14951 if (descr == 0)
14952 return;
14953 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
14954 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
14955 else
14956 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
14959 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
14960 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
14961 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
14962 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
14963 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
14964 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
14965 function above).
14967 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
14968 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
14969 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
14970 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
14971 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
14972 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
14973 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
14974 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
14975 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
14976 function below.) */
14978 static void
14979 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
14981 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
14982 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
14984 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
14986 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
14987 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
14989 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
14990 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
14991 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
14992 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
14994 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
14996 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
14998 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
15000 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
15001 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15002 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15004 /* Extract the vtable address. */
15005 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15006 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15008 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
15009 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
15010 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
15012 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
15013 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15014 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
15015 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15017 /* Extract the offset. */
15018 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15019 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15021 /* Add it to the object address. */
15022 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
15023 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15025 else
15026 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
15028 else
15029 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
15031 if (! loc_descr)
15033 if (dwarf_version > 2)
15035 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
15036 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
15037 return;
15039 else
15041 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15043 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
15044 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
15045 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
15047 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
15048 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
15049 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
15050 stack. */
15051 op = DW_OP_constu;
15052 #else
15053 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
15054 #endif
15056 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
15060 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
15063 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
15065 static void
15066 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
15068 while (size != 0)
15070 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
15071 val >>= 8;
15072 --size;
15076 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
15078 static HOST_WIDE_INT
15079 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
15081 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
15083 src += size;
15084 while (size != 0)
15086 val <<= 8;
15087 val |= *--src & 0xff;
15088 --size;
15090 return val;
15093 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
15095 static void
15096 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
15098 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
15099 long val[4];
15100 int i;
15102 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
15103 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
15105 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
15106 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
15108 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
15109 array += 4;
15113 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
15114 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
15115 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
15116 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
15117 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
15119 static bool
15120 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
15122 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15124 case CONST_INT:
15126 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
15128 if (val < 0)
15129 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
15130 else
15131 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
15133 return true;
15135 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15136 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
15137 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
15138 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
15139 represented. */
15141 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15143 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15145 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
15146 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length);
15148 insert_float (rtl, array);
15149 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
15151 else
15152 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
15153 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
15155 return true;
15157 case CONST_VECTOR:
15159 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15160 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
15161 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
15162 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length * elt_size);
15163 unsigned int i;
15164 unsigned char *p;
15166 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
15168 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
15169 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15171 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15172 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
15174 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
15176 case CONST_INT:
15177 lo = INTVAL (elt);
15178 hi = -(lo < 0);
15179 break;
15181 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15182 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
15183 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
15184 break;
15186 default:
15187 gcc_unreachable ();
15190 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
15191 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
15192 else
15194 unsigned char *p0 = p;
15195 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
15197 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
15198 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15200 p0 = p1;
15201 p1 = p;
15203 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
15204 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
15207 break;
15209 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
15210 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15212 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15213 insert_float (elt, p);
15215 break;
15217 default:
15218 gcc_unreachable ();
15221 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
15223 return true;
15225 case CONST_STRING:
15226 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
15227 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
15228 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
15229 return true;
15231 case CONST:
15232 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15233 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
15234 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15235 case SYMBOL_REF:
15236 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15237 return false;
15238 case LABEL_REF:
15239 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
15240 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
15241 return true;
15243 case PLUS:
15244 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
15245 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
15246 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
15247 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
15248 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
15249 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
15250 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
15251 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
15252 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
15253 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
15254 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
15255 return false;
15257 case HIGH:
15258 case CONST_FIXED:
15259 return false;
15261 case MEM:
15262 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
15263 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
15264 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
15266 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
15267 return true;
15269 return false;
15271 default:
15272 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
15273 gcc_unreachable ();
15275 return false;
15278 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
15279 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
15280 output). */
15281 static tree
15282 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
15283 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15285 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
15286 *walk_subtrees = 0;
15288 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
15289 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
15290 return *tp;
15291 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
15292 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
15293 be conservative. */
15294 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
15295 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
15296 return *tp;
15297 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
15299 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_node (*tp);
15300 if (!node->needed)
15301 return *tp;
15303 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
15304 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
15306 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
15307 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
15308 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
15309 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
15310 if (!cgraph_get_node (*tp))
15311 return *tp;
15313 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
15314 return *tp;
15316 return NULL_TREE;
15319 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
15320 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
15322 static rtx
15323 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
15325 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
15327 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
15328 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
15329 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15331 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
15332 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
15333 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
15335 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
15336 && domain
15337 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
15338 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
15339 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
15340 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
15341 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
15343 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
15344 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
15345 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
15346 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
15349 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
15350 CONCAT: FIXME! */
15351 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
15353 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
15354 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
15355 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
15357 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
15358 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
15359 reference variables which won't be output. */
15360 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
15361 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
15363 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
15364 possible. */
15365 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
15366 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
15368 case VECTOR_CST:
15369 break;
15370 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15371 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
15373 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
15374 bool constant_p = true;
15375 tree value;
15376 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
15378 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
15379 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
15380 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
15381 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
15382 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
15384 constant_p = false;
15385 break;
15388 if (constant_p)
15390 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
15391 break;
15394 /* FALLTHRU */
15396 default:
15397 return NULL;
15400 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
15402 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
15403 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
15406 return rtl;
15409 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
15411 static rtx
15412 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
15414 rtx rtl;
15416 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
15417 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
15418 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
15420 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
15421 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
15422 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
15423 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
15424 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
15425 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
15426 referenced within the function.
15428 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
15429 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
15430 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
15431 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
15433 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
15434 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
15435 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
15436 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
15437 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
15438 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
15440 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
15441 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
15442 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
15443 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
15444 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
15445 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
15446 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
15447 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
15448 output at debug-time.
15450 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
15451 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
15452 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
15453 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
15454 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
15455 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
15456 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
15457 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
15458 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
15459 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
15460 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
15461 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
15462 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
15464 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
15465 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
15466 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
15467 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
15468 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
15469 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
15470 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
15471 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
15472 I'd like to fix it.
15474 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
15475 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
15476 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
15477 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
15478 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
15479 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
15480 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
15481 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
15482 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
15483 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
15484 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
15486 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
15487 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
15489 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
15490 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
15491 fixed registers. */
15492 if (! reload_completed)
15494 if (rtl
15495 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
15496 || (MEM_P (rtl)
15497 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15498 || (REG_P (rtl)
15499 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
15500 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
15502 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15503 return rtl;
15505 rtl = NULL_RTX;
15507 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
15509 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
15511 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
15512 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
15513 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
15514 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
15516 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
15517 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
15518 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
15519 if (dmode == pmode)
15520 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
15521 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
15522 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
15523 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
15525 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
15526 if (REG_P (inc))
15527 rtl = inc;
15528 else if (MEM_P (inc))
15530 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
15531 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
15532 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
15533 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
15534 else
15535 rtl = inc;
15540 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
15541 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
15542 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
15543 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
15544 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
15545 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
15546 thing to do. */
15547 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
15548 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
15549 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15550 /* Not passed in memory. */
15551 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
15552 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
15553 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15554 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
15555 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
15556 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
15557 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
15558 #endif
15560 /* Big endian correction check. */
15561 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
15562 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
15563 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
15564 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
15566 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
15567 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
15569 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
15570 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
15573 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
15574 && rtl
15575 && MEM_P (rtl)
15576 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
15577 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
15579 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
15580 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
15582 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
15583 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
15584 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
15585 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
15586 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
15587 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
15588 if (rsize > dsize)
15589 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
15590 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
15593 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
15594 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
15595 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
15596 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
15597 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
15599 if (rtl)
15600 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15602 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
15603 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
15604 code, and thus is not emitted. */
15605 if (rtl)
15606 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15608 return rtl;
15611 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
15612 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
15613 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
15615 static tree
15616 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
15618 tree val_expr, cvar;
15619 enum machine_mode mode;
15620 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
15621 tree offset;
15622 int volatilep = 0, unsignedp = 0;
15624 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't public or static, or if
15625 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
15626 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
15627 be handled as such. */
15628 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
15629 || !TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
15630 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
15631 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
15632 || !is_fortran ())
15633 return NULL_TREE;
15635 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
15636 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
15637 return NULL_TREE;
15639 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
15640 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
15642 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
15643 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
15644 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
15645 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
15646 return NULL_TREE;
15648 *value = 0;
15649 if (offset != NULL)
15651 if (!host_integerp (offset, 0))
15652 return NULL_TREE;
15653 *value = tree_low_cst (offset, 0);
15655 if (bitpos != 0)
15656 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15658 return cvar;
15661 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
15662 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
15663 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
15664 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
15665 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
15666 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
15667 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
15668 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
15669 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
15670 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
15672 static bool
15673 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
15674 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
15676 rtx rtl;
15677 dw_loc_list_ref list;
15678 var_loc_list *loc_list;
15680 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15681 return false;
15683 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
15684 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
15686 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
15687 the location. */
15689 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
15690 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
15691 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
15692 return true;
15694 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
15695 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
15696 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
15697 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
15698 if (loc_list && loc_list->first && loc_list->first == loc_list->last)
15700 enum var_init_status status;
15701 struct var_loc_node *node;
15703 node = loc_list->first;
15704 status = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
15705 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
15706 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == VAR_LOCATION
15707 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
15708 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0);
15709 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
15710 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
15711 return true;
15713 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2);
15714 if (list)
15716 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, list);
15717 return true;
15719 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
15720 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
15721 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
15724 /* Add VARIABLE and DIE into deferred locations list. */
15726 static void
15727 defer_location (tree variable, dw_die_ref die)
15729 deferred_locations entry;
15730 entry.variable = variable;
15731 entry.die = die;
15732 VEC_safe_push (deferred_locations, gc, deferred_locations_list, &entry);
15735 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
15736 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
15738 static bool
15739 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
15741 tree type;
15743 if (init == NULL_TREE)
15744 return false;
15746 STRIP_NOPS (init);
15747 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
15749 case STRING_CST:
15750 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
15751 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15753 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
15754 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
15756 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
15757 return false;
15758 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
15759 return false;
15760 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
15762 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
15763 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
15764 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
15765 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
15767 else
15768 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
15769 return true;
15771 return false;
15772 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15773 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
15774 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
15775 return false;
15776 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15778 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
15779 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
15780 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
15781 constructor_elt *ce;
15783 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
15784 || !host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0))
15785 return false;
15787 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
15788 if (fieldsize <= 0)
15789 return false;
15791 min_index = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0);
15792 memset (array, '\0', size);
15793 for (cnt = 0;
15794 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce);
15795 cnt++)
15797 tree val = ce->value;
15798 tree index = ce->index;
15799 int pos = curpos;
15800 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
15801 pos = (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0) - min_index)
15802 * fieldsize;
15803 else if (index)
15804 pos = (tree_low_cst (index, 0) - min_index) * fieldsize;
15806 if (val)
15808 STRIP_NOPS (val);
15809 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
15810 return false;
15812 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
15813 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
15815 int count = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1), 0)
15816 - tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0);
15817 while (count > 0)
15819 if (val)
15820 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
15821 curpos += fieldsize;
15824 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
15826 return true;
15828 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
15829 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
15831 tree field = NULL_TREE;
15832 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
15833 constructor_elt *ce;
15835 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
15836 return false;
15838 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
15839 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
15841 for (cnt = 0;
15842 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce);
15843 cnt++, field = field ? TREE_CHAIN (field) : 0)
15845 tree val = ce->value;
15846 int pos, fieldsize;
15848 if (ce->index != 0)
15849 field = ce->index;
15851 if (val)
15852 STRIP_NOPS (val);
15854 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
15855 return false;
15857 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
15858 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
15859 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
15860 return false;
15861 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
15862 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0))
15863 return false;
15864 fieldsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0);
15865 pos = int_byte_position (field);
15866 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
15867 if (val
15868 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
15869 return false;
15871 return true;
15873 return false;
15874 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
15875 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
15876 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
15877 default:
15878 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
15882 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
15883 attribute is the const value T. */
15885 static bool
15886 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
15888 tree init;
15889 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
15890 rtx rtl;
15892 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
15893 return false;
15895 init = t;
15896 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
15898 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
15899 if (rtl)
15900 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
15901 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
15902 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
15903 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
15905 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
15906 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
15908 unsigned char *array = GGC_CNEWVEC (unsigned char, size);
15910 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
15912 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
15913 return true;
15917 return false;
15920 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
15921 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
15922 variable with static storage duration
15923 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
15925 static bool
15926 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
15929 if (!decl
15930 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
15931 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL))
15932 return false;
15934 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
15935 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
15936 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
15937 /* OK */;
15938 else
15939 return false;
15941 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
15942 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
15943 return false;
15945 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
15948 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
15949 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
15950 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
15951 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
15952 expressions. */
15954 static dw_loc_list_ref
15955 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
15957 dw_fde_ref fde;
15958 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
15959 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
15960 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
15961 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
15962 dw_cfa_location remember;
15964 fde = current_fde ();
15965 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
15967 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
15968 list_tail = &list;
15969 list = NULL;
15971 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
15972 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
15973 remember = next_cfa;
15975 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
15977 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
15978 advance opcodes. */
15979 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
15980 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
15982 last_cfa = next_cfa;
15983 last_label = start_label;
15985 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
15986 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
15988 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
15989 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
15990 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
15991 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
15992 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
15994 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
15995 start_label, last_label, section,
15996 list == NULL);
15998 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
15999 last_cfa = next_cfa;
16000 start_label = last_label;
16002 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
16003 break;
16005 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
16006 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
16007 gcc_unreachable ();
16009 default:
16010 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
16011 break;
16014 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
16016 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16017 start_label, last_label, section,
16018 list == NULL);
16019 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16020 start_label = last_label;
16022 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
16023 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
16024 list == NULL);
16026 return list;
16029 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
16030 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
16031 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
16032 before the latter is negated. */
16034 static void
16035 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16037 rtx reg, elim;
16039 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
16040 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
16041 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16042 #else
16043 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
16044 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16045 #endif
16047 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
16048 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
16050 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
16051 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
16054 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
16055 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16056 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
16057 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
16058 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16059 : stack_pointer_rtx));
16061 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
16064 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
16065 the value of the attribute. */
16067 static void
16068 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
16070 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
16072 if (demangle_name_func)
16073 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
16075 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
16079 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
16081 static void
16082 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
16084 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
16085 char *wd1;
16087 if (wd == NULL)
16088 return;
16090 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
16092 int wdlen;
16094 wdlen = strlen (wd);
16095 wd1 = GGC_NEWVEC (char, wdlen + 2);
16096 strcpy (wd1, wd);
16097 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
16098 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
16099 wd = wd1;
16102 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, remap_debug_filename (wd));
16105 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
16106 a representation for that bound. */
16108 static void
16109 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
16111 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
16113 case ERROR_MARK:
16114 return;
16116 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
16117 case INTEGER_CST:
16119 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (bound));
16121 /* Use the default if possible. */
16122 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
16123 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
16124 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound))))
16127 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with the
16128 precision of its type. The precision and signedness of the
16129 type will be necessary to re-interpret it unambiguously. */
16130 else if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
16132 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
16133 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1;
16134 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
16135 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound) & mask);
16137 else if (prec == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
16138 || TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound) == 0)
16139 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
16140 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
16141 else
16142 add_AT_double (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound),
16143 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
16145 break;
16147 CASE_CONVERT:
16148 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16149 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
16150 break;
16152 case SAVE_EXPR:
16153 break;
16155 case VAR_DECL:
16156 case PARM_DECL:
16157 case RESULT_DECL:
16159 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
16160 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
16162 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
16163 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
16164 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
16165 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
16166 later parameter. */
16167 if (decl_die != NULL)
16168 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
16169 else
16171 loc = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0);
16172 add_AT_location_description (subrange_die, bound_attr, loc);
16174 break;
16177 default:
16179 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
16180 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
16182 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
16183 dw_loc_list_ref list;
16185 list = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 2);
16186 if (list == NULL)
16187 break;
16189 if (current_function_decl == 0)
16190 ctx = comp_unit_die;
16191 else
16192 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
16194 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
16195 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16196 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
16197 if (list->dw_loc_next)
16198 add_AT_loc_list (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
16199 else
16200 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list->expr);
16202 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
16203 break;
16208 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
16209 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
16210 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
16211 includes information about the element type of the given array type. */
16213 static void
16214 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
16216 unsigned dimension_number;
16217 tree lower, upper;
16218 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
16220 for (dimension_number = 0;
16221 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
16222 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
16224 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
16226 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
16227 break;
16229 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
16230 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
16231 here. */
16232 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
16233 if (domain)
16235 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
16236 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
16237 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
16239 /* Define the index type. */
16240 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
16242 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
16243 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
16244 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
16245 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
16246 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
16247 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
16248 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
16250 else
16251 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
16252 type_die);
16255 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
16256 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
16257 dimension arr(N:*)
16258 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
16259 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
16260 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
16262 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
16263 if (upper)
16264 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
16267 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
16268 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
16269 bounds. */
16273 static void
16274 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
16276 unsigned size;
16278 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
16280 case ERROR_MARK:
16281 size = 0;
16282 break;
16283 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
16284 case RECORD_TYPE:
16285 case UNION_TYPE:
16286 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
16287 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
16288 break;
16289 case FIELD_DECL:
16290 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
16291 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
16292 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
16293 even for bit-fields. */
16294 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16295 break;
16296 default:
16297 gcc_unreachable ();
16300 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
16301 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
16302 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
16303 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
16304 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
16307 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
16308 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
16309 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
16310 bit-field itself.
16312 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
16313 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
16314 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
16315 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
16316 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
16317 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
16319 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
16320 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
16321 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
16323 static inline void
16324 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16326 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
16327 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
16328 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
16329 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
16330 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
16331 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
16333 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
16334 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
16336 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
16337 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
16338 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
16339 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
16340 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
16341 return;
16343 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
16345 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
16346 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
16347 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
16348 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
16349 below must take account of these differences. */
16350 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16351 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
16353 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
16355 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
16356 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
16359 bit_offset
16360 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
16361 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
16362 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
16364 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
16367 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
16368 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
16370 static inline void
16371 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16373 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
16374 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
16375 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
16377 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
16378 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
16381 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
16382 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
16384 static inline void
16385 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
16387 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
16388 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
16389 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
16392 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
16393 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
16394 equate table. */
16396 static inline dw_die_ref
16397 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
16399 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
16401 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
16403 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
16404 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
16405 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
16407 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
16408 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
16409 tree fn = origin;
16411 if (TYPE_P (fn))
16412 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
16414 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
16415 if (fn)
16416 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
16419 if (DECL_P (origin))
16420 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
16421 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
16422 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
16424 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
16425 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
16426 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
16427 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
16428 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
16429 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
16430 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
16431 here. */
16433 if (origin_die)
16434 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
16435 return origin_die;
16438 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
16440 static inline void
16441 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
16443 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
16445 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
16447 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
16448 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
16449 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
16450 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
16451 0));
16453 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
16454 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
16455 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
16456 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
16460 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
16462 static void
16463 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16465 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
16467 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
16468 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
16471 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
16472 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
16474 static void
16475 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16477 tree decl_name;
16479 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
16480 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
16482 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
16483 if (name)
16484 add_name_attribute (die, name);
16485 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
16486 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
16488 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
16489 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
16490 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
16491 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
16492 && !is_fortran ())
16494 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
16495 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
16497 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
16499 asm_name = GGC_CNEW (limbo_die_node);
16500 asm_name->die = die;
16501 asm_name->created_for = decl;
16502 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
16503 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
16505 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
16506 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
16507 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
16511 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16512 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
16513 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
16514 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
16516 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
16517 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
16518 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
16520 #endif
16523 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
16525 static void
16526 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
16528 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
16531 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
16533 static inline void
16534 pop_decl_scope (void)
16536 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
16539 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
16540 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
16541 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
16542 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
16543 the current active scope. */
16545 static dw_die_ref
16546 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
16548 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
16549 tree containing_scope;
16550 int i;
16552 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
16553 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
16555 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
16557 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
16558 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
16560 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
16561 /* OK */;
16562 else
16563 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
16566 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
16567 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
16568 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
16569 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
16570 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
16572 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
16573 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
16574 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
16576 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
16577 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
16578 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
16579 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
16580 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
16581 break;
16583 if (i < 0)
16585 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
16586 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
16588 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
16589 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
16591 else
16592 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
16594 else
16595 scope_die = context_die;
16597 return scope_die;
16600 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
16602 static inline int
16603 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
16605 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
16606 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
16607 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
16608 return 1;
16610 return 0;
16613 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
16615 static inline int
16616 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
16618 return (context_die
16619 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
16620 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
16621 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
16622 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
16625 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
16626 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
16628 static inline int
16629 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
16631 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
16632 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
16635 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
16636 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
16637 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
16639 static void
16640 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
16641 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
16643 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
16644 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
16646 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
16647 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
16648 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
16649 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
16650 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
16651 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
16652 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
16654 if (code == ERROR_MARK
16655 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
16656 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
16657 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
16658 || code == VOID_TYPE)
16659 return;
16661 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
16662 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
16663 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
16664 context_die);
16666 if (type_die != NULL)
16667 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
16670 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
16671 function call type. */
16672 static void
16673 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
16675 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
16677 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
16678 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
16680 /* DWARF doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
16681 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
16682 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
16683 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we use this for the
16684 time being, following existing custom. */
16685 if (is_fortran ()
16686 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
16687 value = DW_CC_program;
16689 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
16690 is not DW_CC_normal. */
16691 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
16692 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
16695 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
16696 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
16697 was declared without a tag. */
16699 static const char *
16700 type_tag (const_tree type)
16702 const char *name = 0;
16704 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
16706 tree t = 0;
16708 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
16709 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
16710 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
16712 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
16713 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
16714 involved. */
16715 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
16716 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
16718 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
16719 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
16720 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
16721 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
16722 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
16723 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
16726 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
16727 if (!name && t != 0)
16728 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
16731 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
16734 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
16735 for bit field types. */
16737 static inline tree
16738 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
16740 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
16741 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
16744 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
16745 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
16747 #if 0
16748 static const char *
16749 decl_start_label (tree decl)
16751 rtx x;
16752 const char *fnname;
16754 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
16755 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
16757 x = XEXP (x, 0);
16758 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
16760 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
16761 return fnname;
16763 #endif
16765 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
16766 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
16767 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
16769 static void
16770 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
16772 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
16773 dw_die_ref array_die;
16775 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
16776 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
16777 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
16778 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
16779 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
16780 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
16781 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
16782 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
16783 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
16785 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
16786 tree element_type;
16788 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
16789 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
16790 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
16791 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
16792 && is_fortran ()
16793 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
16795 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
16797 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
16798 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
16799 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
16800 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
16801 if (size >= 0)
16802 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
16803 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
16804 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
16805 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
16807 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
16808 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2);
16810 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
16811 if (loc && size > 0)
16813 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
16814 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16815 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
16818 return;
16821 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types
16822 (e.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10]) unless the inner
16823 array type comes before the outer array type. We thus call gen_type_die
16824 before we new_die and must prevent nested array types collapsing for this
16825 target. */
16827 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16828 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
16829 collapse_nested_arrays = false;
16830 #endif
16832 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
16833 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
16834 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
16836 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
16838 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
16839 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
16840 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
16841 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
16844 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
16845 if (is_fortran ()
16846 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
16847 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
16848 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
16849 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
16851 #if 0
16852 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
16853 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
16854 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
16855 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
16856 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
16857 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
16858 for multidimensional arrays. */
16859 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
16860 #endif
16862 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16863 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
16864 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
16865 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
16866 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
16867 else
16868 #endif
16869 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
16871 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
16872 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
16873 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
16874 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
16875 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16877 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
16878 break;
16879 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
16882 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16883 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
16884 #endif
16886 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
16888 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
16889 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
16892 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16893 descr_info_loc (tree val, tree base_decl)
16895 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
16896 dw_loc_descr_ref loc, loc2;
16897 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16899 if (val == base_decl)
16900 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
16902 switch (TREE_CODE (val))
16904 CASE_CONVERT:
16905 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16906 case VAR_DECL:
16907 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, 0);
16908 case INTEGER_CST:
16909 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
16910 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val, 0));
16911 break;
16912 case INDIRECT_REF:
16913 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val));
16914 if (size < 0)
16915 break;
16916 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16917 if (!loc)
16918 break;
16919 if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16920 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
16921 else
16922 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size, size, 0));
16923 return loc;
16924 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
16925 case PLUS_EXPR:
16926 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
16927 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
16928 < 16384)
16930 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16931 if (!loc)
16932 break;
16933 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 0));
16935 else
16937 op = DW_OP_plus;
16938 do_binop:
16939 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16940 if (!loc)
16941 break;
16942 loc2 = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), base_decl);
16943 if (!loc2)
16944 break;
16945 add_loc_descr (&loc, loc2);
16946 add_loc_descr (&loc2, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16948 return loc;
16949 case MINUS_EXPR:
16950 op = DW_OP_minus;
16951 goto do_binop;
16952 case MULT_EXPR:
16953 op = DW_OP_mul;
16954 goto do_binop;
16955 case EQ_EXPR:
16956 op = DW_OP_eq;
16957 goto do_binop;
16958 case NE_EXPR:
16959 op = DW_OP_ne;
16960 goto do_binop;
16961 default:
16962 break;
16964 return NULL;
16967 static void
16968 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr,
16969 tree val, tree base_decl)
16971 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
16973 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
16975 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, tree_low_cst (val, 0));
16976 return;
16979 loc = descr_info_loc (val, base_decl);
16980 if (!loc)
16981 return;
16983 add_AT_loc (die, attr, loc);
16986 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
16987 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
16989 static void
16990 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
16991 dw_die_ref context_die)
16993 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
16994 dw_die_ref array_die;
16995 int dim;
16997 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
16998 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
16999 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17001 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
17002 if (is_fortran ()
17003 && info->ndimensions >= 2)
17004 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
17006 if (info->data_location)
17007 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
17008 info->base_decl);
17009 if (info->associated)
17010 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
17011 info->base_decl);
17012 if (info->allocated)
17013 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
17014 info->base_decl);
17016 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
17018 dw_die_ref subrange_die
17019 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
17021 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
17023 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
17024 if ((is_c_family () || is_java ())
17025 && integer_zerop (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound))
17027 else if (is_fortran ()
17028 && integer_onep (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound))
17030 else
17031 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
17032 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound,
17033 info->base_decl);
17035 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
17036 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
17037 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound,
17038 info->base_decl);
17039 if (info->dimen[dim].stride)
17040 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
17041 info->dimen[dim].stride,
17042 info->base_decl);
17045 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
17046 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
17048 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
17049 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
17052 #if 0
17053 static void
17054 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17056 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17057 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
17059 if (origin != NULL)
17060 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
17061 else
17063 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
17064 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17065 0, 0, context_die);
17068 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
17069 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
17070 else
17071 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
17073 #endif
17075 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
17076 emit full debugging info for them. */
17078 static void
17079 retry_incomplete_types (void)
17081 int i;
17083 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
17084 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
17087 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
17089 static enum dwarf_tag
17090 record_type_tag (tree type)
17092 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
17093 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17095 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
17097 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
17098 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17100 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
17101 return DW_TAG_class_type;
17103 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
17104 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17105 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
17106 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17108 default:
17109 gcc_unreachable ();
17113 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
17114 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
17115 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
17116 DIE. */
17118 static dw_die_ref
17119 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17121 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
17123 if (type_die == NULL)
17125 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
17126 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
17127 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
17128 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
17130 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
17131 return type_die;
17132 else
17133 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17135 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
17136 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
17137 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
17138 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
17140 tree link;
17142 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
17143 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
17144 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
17145 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
17147 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
17148 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
17149 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
17150 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
17152 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
17153 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
17155 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
17156 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
17158 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
17159 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
17161 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
17162 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
17164 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
17165 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
17166 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
17167 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
17168 values as if they were signed. That means that
17169 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
17170 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
17171 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
17172 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
17175 else
17176 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17178 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
17179 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
17181 return type_die;
17184 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
17185 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
17186 type.
17188 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
17189 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
17190 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
17191 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
17192 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
17193 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
17194 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
17195 argument type of some subprogram type.
17196 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
17197 are emitted. */
17199 static dw_die_ref
17200 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
17201 dw_die_ref context_die)
17203 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
17204 dw_die_ref parm_die
17205 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
17207 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
17209 case tcc_declaration:
17210 if (!origin)
17211 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
17212 if (origin != NULL)
17213 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
17214 else
17216 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node);
17217 if (emit_name_p)
17218 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
17219 if (decl_by_reference_p (node))
17220 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0,
17221 context_die);
17222 else
17223 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
17224 TREE_READONLY (node),
17225 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
17226 context_die);
17227 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
17228 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17231 if (node && node != origin)
17232 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
17233 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin))
17234 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
17235 DW_AT_location);
17237 break;
17239 case tcc_type:
17240 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
17241 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, 0, 0, context_die);
17242 break;
17244 default:
17245 gcc_unreachable ();
17248 return parm_die;
17251 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
17252 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
17253 parameter pack.
17255 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
17256 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
17257 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
17258 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
17259 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
17260 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
17262 static dw_die_ref
17263 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
17264 tree pack_arg,
17265 dw_die_ref subr_die,
17266 tree *next_arg)
17268 tree arg;
17269 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
17271 gcc_assert (parm_pack
17272 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
17273 && subr_die);
17275 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
17276 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
17278 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
17280 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
17281 parm_pack))
17282 break;
17283 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
17284 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
17285 parm_pack_die);
17287 if (next_arg)
17288 *next_arg = arg;
17289 return parm_pack_die;
17292 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
17293 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
17295 static void
17296 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17298 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
17301 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
17302 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
17303 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
17304 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
17306 static void
17307 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17309 tree link;
17310 tree formal_type = NULL;
17311 tree first_parm_type;
17312 tree arg;
17314 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
17316 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
17317 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
17319 else
17320 arg = NULL_TREE;
17322 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
17324 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
17325 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
17326 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
17328 dw_die_ref parm_die;
17330 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
17331 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
17332 break;
17334 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
17335 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
17336 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
17337 context_die);
17338 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
17339 && link == first_parm_type)
17340 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
17341 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17343 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
17344 if (arg)
17345 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
17348 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
17349 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
17350 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
17351 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
17353 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
17354 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
17355 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
17356 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
17357 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
17358 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
17361 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
17362 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
17363 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
17364 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
17365 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
17367 static void
17368 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
17370 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
17372 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
17373 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
17374 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
17375 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
17377 dw_die_ref type_die;
17378 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
17380 push_decl_scope (type);
17381 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
17382 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
17383 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
17384 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
17386 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
17387 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
17388 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
17389 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
17390 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
17392 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
17393 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
17396 else
17397 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
17399 pop_decl_scope ();
17403 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
17404 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
17406 static void
17407 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
17409 dw_die_ref old_die;
17410 tree save_fn;
17411 tree context;
17412 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
17413 htab_t old_decl_loc_table;
17415 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
17416 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
17418 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
17419 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17420 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
17421 return;
17423 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
17424 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
17425 get locations in abstract instantces. */
17426 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
17427 decl_loc_table = NULL;
17429 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
17430 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
17431 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17433 context = decl_class_context (decl);
17434 if (context)
17435 gen_type_die_for_member
17436 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
17439 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
17440 save_fn = current_function_decl;
17441 current_function_decl = decl;
17442 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
17444 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
17445 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
17446 if (! was_abstract)
17447 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
17449 current_function_decl = save_fn;
17450 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
17451 pop_cfun ();
17454 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
17455 htab_traverse.
17457 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
17458 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
17460 static int
17461 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17463 tree type;
17464 dw_die_ref die;
17466 type = (tree) *slot;
17467 die = lookup_type_die (type);
17468 if (die != NULL)
17469 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
17470 return 1;
17473 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
17474 through htab_traverse.
17476 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
17477 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
17478 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
17480 static int
17481 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (void **slot,
17482 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17484 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
17485 dw_die_ref die;
17487 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
17488 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
17489 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
17490 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
17491 if (die)
17493 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
17494 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
17495 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_node (entry->var_decl);
17496 if (node->needed)
17498 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
17499 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
17500 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
17501 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
17504 return 1;
17507 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
17509 static void
17510 premark_used_types (void)
17512 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
17513 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
17516 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
17518 static void
17519 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
17521 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
17522 htab_traverse (types_used_by_vars_hash,
17523 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper, NULL);
17526 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
17527 block-local). */
17529 static void
17530 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17532 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17533 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17534 dw_die_ref subr_die;
17535 tree fn_arg_types;
17536 tree outer_scope;
17537 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
17538 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
17539 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
17541 premark_used_types ();
17543 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
17544 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
17545 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
17546 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
17547 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
17549 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
17550 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
17552 origin = NULL;
17553 gcc_assert (!old_die);
17556 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
17557 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
17558 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
17559 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
17560 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
17561 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17562 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
17564 if (origin != NULL)
17566 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
17568 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
17569 inline function. */
17570 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
17571 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
17573 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
17574 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
17576 else if (old_die)
17578 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
17579 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
17581 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
17582 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
17583 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
17584 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
17585 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17587 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
17588 something we have already output. */
17589 return;
17592 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
17593 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
17594 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
17595 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
17596 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
17597 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
17598 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
17599 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
17600 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
17601 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
17602 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
17603 == (unsigned) s.line))))
17605 subr_die = old_die;
17607 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
17608 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
17609 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
17610 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
17611 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
17612 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17613 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
17615 else
17617 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
17618 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
17619 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
17620 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
17621 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
17622 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
17625 else
17627 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
17629 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
17630 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
17632 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
17633 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17635 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
17636 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17637 0, 0, context_die);
17640 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
17641 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17642 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17644 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
17645 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
17646 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
17647 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
17650 if (declaration)
17652 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17654 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17656 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
17657 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
17658 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
17659 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
17660 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
17662 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
17663 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
17664 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
17665 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
17667 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
17668 later reused to represent definition. */
17669 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17672 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
17674 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
17676 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
17677 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
17678 else
17679 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
17681 else
17683 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
17684 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
17685 else
17686 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
17689 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
17690 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
17691 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17693 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17695 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
17697 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
17699 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17700 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17702 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
17704 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
17705 current_function_funcdef_no);
17706 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
17707 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
17708 current_function_funcdef_no);
17709 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
17711 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
17712 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
17714 else
17715 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
17716 hot section and one for cold section, then use the hot/cold
17717 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
17719 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
17720 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
17721 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
17722 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
17724 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
17725 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
17726 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
17730 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17731 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
17732 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
17733 #endif
17735 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
17737 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
17738 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
17739 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
17740 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
17741 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
17742 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
17743 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
17744 function. */
17745 if (dwarf_version >= 3)
17747 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
17748 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
17750 else
17752 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
17753 if (list->dw_loc_next)
17754 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
17755 else
17756 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
17759 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
17760 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
17761 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
17762 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
17763 by this displacement. */
17764 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
17766 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
17767 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
17768 loc_list_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl, 2));
17771 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
17772 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17773 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
17775 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
17776 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
17777 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
17778 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
17779 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
17780 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
17781 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
17782 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
17783 an ellipsis at the end. */
17785 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
17786 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
17787 its formal parameters. */
17788 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17790 else if (declaration)
17791 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
17792 else
17794 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
17795 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
17796 tree generic_decl = lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl);
17797 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
17798 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
17799 : NULL;
17801 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
17802 emit their relevant DIEs.
17804 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
17805 as well as it being a normal function.
17807 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
17808 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
17809 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
17810 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
17811 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
17812 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
17813 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
17814 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
17815 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
17816 children DIE.
17818 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
17819 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
17821 if (generic_decl_parm
17822 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
17823 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
17824 parm, subr_die,
17825 &parm);
17826 else if (parm)
17828 gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, subr_die);
17829 parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm);
17832 if (generic_decl_parm)
17833 generic_decl_parm = TREE_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
17836 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
17837 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
17838 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
17839 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
17840 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
17841 parameters at all. */
17842 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
17843 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
17845 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
17846 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
17847 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
17849 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
17850 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
17853 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
17854 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
17855 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
17857 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
17858 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
17859 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
17860 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
17861 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
17862 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
17863 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
17865 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
17866 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
17867 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
17868 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
17869 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
17870 constructor function. */
17871 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
17873 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
17874 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
17875 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, subr_die);
17877 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
17878 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
17880 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
17881 if (current_function_has_inlines)
17883 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
17884 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
17886 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
17887 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
17890 #endif
17892 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
17893 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
17897 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
17899 static hashval_t
17900 common_block_die_table_hash (const void *x)
17902 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
17903 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
17906 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
17907 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
17909 static int
17910 common_block_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
17912 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
17913 const_dw_die_ref e = (const_dw_die_ref) y;
17914 return d->decl_id == e->decl_id && d->die_parent == e->die_parent;
17917 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
17918 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
17920 static void
17921 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
17923 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
17924 tree com_decl;
17925 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
17926 dw_die_ref var_die;
17927 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
17928 dw_die_ref origin_die;
17929 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
17930 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
17931 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
17932 might end up being no definition anywhere in
17933 the program. For example, consider the C++
17934 test case:
17936 template <class T>
17937 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
17939 template <class T>
17940 const int S<T>::i;
17942 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
17944 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
17945 definition is required, so the compiler will
17946 not emit a definition. */
17947 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
17948 && DECL_COMDAT (decl_or_origin)
17949 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl_or_origin))
17950 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
17952 if (!origin)
17953 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17955 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
17957 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
17958 of a data member. */
17959 if (com_decl)
17961 tree field;
17962 dw_die_ref com_die;
17963 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
17964 die_node com_die_arg;
17966 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
17967 if (var_die)
17969 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
17971 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2);
17972 if (loc)
17974 if (off)
17976 /* Optimize the common case. */
17977 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
17978 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
17979 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
17980 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
17981 == SYMBOL_REF)
17982 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
17983 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
17984 else
17985 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
17987 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
17988 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17991 return;
17994 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
17995 common_block_die_table
17996 = htab_create_ggc (10, common_block_die_table_hash,
17997 common_block_die_table_eq, NULL);
17999 field = TREE_OPERAND (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl), 0);
18000 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
18001 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
18002 com_die = (dw_die_ref) htab_find (common_block_die_table, &com_die_arg);
18003 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
18004 if (com_die == NULL)
18006 const char *cnam
18007 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
18008 void **slot;
18010 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
18011 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
18012 if (loc)
18014 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
18015 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
18016 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
18017 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
18019 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
18020 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18021 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
18022 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
18023 slot = htab_find_slot (common_block_die_table, com_die, INSERT);
18024 *slot = (void *) com_die;
18026 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
18028 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
18029 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
18030 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18032 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
18033 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
18034 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
18035 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
18036 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18037 if (loc)
18039 if (off)
18041 /* Optimize the common case. */
18042 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
18043 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
18044 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
18045 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
18046 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
18047 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
18048 else
18049 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
18051 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
18053 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
18054 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18055 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
18056 return;
18059 /* If the compiler emitted a definition for the DECL declaration
18060 and if we already emitted a DIE for it, don't emit a second
18061 DIE for it again. */
18062 if (old_die
18063 && declaration
18064 && old_die->die_parent == context_die)
18065 return;
18067 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
18068 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
18069 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
18070 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
18071 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
18072 else
18073 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
18075 origin_die = NULL;
18076 if (origin != NULL)
18077 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
18079 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
18080 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
18082 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
18083 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
18084 sharing them.
18086 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
18088 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
18089 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
18090 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
18091 declaration. */
18092 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
18093 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
18095 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
18096 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
18097 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
18099 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18100 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
18102 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
18103 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
18105 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
18106 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18109 else
18111 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18113 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
18114 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl))
18115 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18116 else
18117 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
18118 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
18120 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18121 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18123 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18124 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18126 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
18127 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18128 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
18129 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18132 if (declaration)
18133 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18135 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration))
18136 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
18138 if (! declaration
18139 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
18140 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
18141 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
18142 already set. */
18143 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
18144 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
18145 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
18146 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
18147 to add it again. */
18148 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
18150 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
18151 && !TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl_or_origin)))
18152 defer_location (decl_or_origin, var_die);
18153 else
18154 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die,
18155 decl_or_origin,
18156 DW_AT_location);
18157 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
18159 else
18160 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
18163 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
18165 static void
18166 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18168 dw_die_ref const_die;
18169 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18171 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
18172 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
18173 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, 1, 0, context_die);
18174 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18175 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18176 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18177 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18178 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
18181 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
18183 static void
18184 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18186 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18187 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
18188 rtx insn;
18189 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18191 if (origin != NULL)
18192 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
18193 else
18194 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
18196 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18197 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
18198 else
18200 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
18202 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
18203 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
18204 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
18205 if (insn
18206 && (LABEL_P (insn)
18207 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
18208 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
18210 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
18211 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
18212 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
18213 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
18214 it if it ever does happen. */
18215 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
18217 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
18218 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
18223 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
18224 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
18225 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
18227 static inline void
18228 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
18230 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
18232 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18234 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
18235 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
18240 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
18241 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
18243 static inline void
18244 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
18246 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18248 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
18249 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18251 tree chain;
18253 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
18255 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
18256 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
18257 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
18260 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
18262 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
18265 add_ranges (chain);
18266 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
18268 while (chain);
18269 add_ranges (NULL);
18271 else
18273 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
18274 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
18275 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
18276 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
18277 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
18278 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
18282 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
18284 static void
18285 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18287 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
18289 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
18290 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
18292 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
18295 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
18297 static void
18298 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18300 tree decl;
18302 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
18303 be abstract. */
18304 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
18306 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
18308 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
18309 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
18310 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
18311 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
18312 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
18314 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18316 dw_die_ref subr_die
18317 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
18319 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18320 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
18321 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
18322 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
18324 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
18325 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
18329 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
18331 static void
18332 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18334 dw_die_ref decl_die;
18336 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
18337 return;
18339 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
18340 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
18341 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
18342 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
18343 context_die);
18345 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
18347 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18348 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18349 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18352 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
18353 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18355 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18356 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18358 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
18359 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18360 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
18361 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18363 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
18364 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
18367 #if 0
18368 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
18369 Use modified_type_die instead.
18370 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
18371 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
18373 static void
18374 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18376 dw_die_ref ptr_die
18377 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18379 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
18380 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18381 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
18384 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
18385 Use modified_type_die instead.
18386 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
18387 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
18389 static void
18390 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18392 dw_die_ref ref_die
18393 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18395 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
18396 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18397 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
18399 #endif
18401 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
18403 static void
18404 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18406 dw_die_ref ptr_die
18407 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
18408 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18410 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
18411 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18412 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
18413 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18416 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
18418 static dw_die_ref
18419 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
18421 dw_die_ref die;
18422 char producer[250];
18423 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
18424 int language;
18426 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
18428 if (filename)
18430 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
18431 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
18432 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
18433 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
18436 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
18438 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18439 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
18440 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
18441 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
18442 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
18443 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
18444 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
18445 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18446 strcat (producer, " -g");
18447 #endif
18449 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
18451 language = DW_LANG_C89;
18452 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
18453 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
18454 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
18455 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
18456 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
18457 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
18458 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18460 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
18461 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
18462 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
18463 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
18464 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
18465 language = DW_LANG_Java;
18466 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
18467 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
18468 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
18469 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
18472 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
18473 return die;
18476 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
18478 static void
18479 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
18481 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
18483 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
18484 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
18486 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
18487 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
18489 if (access == access_public_node)
18490 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
18491 else if (access == access_protected_node)
18492 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18495 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
18497 static void
18498 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18500 tree member;
18501 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
18502 dw_die_ref child;
18504 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
18505 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
18506 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
18507 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
18508 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
18509 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
18510 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
18511 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
18512 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
18513 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
18514 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
18516 /* First output info about the base classes. */
18517 if (binfo)
18519 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
18520 int i;
18521 tree base;
18523 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
18524 gen_inheritance_die (base,
18525 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
18526 : access_public_node), context_die);
18529 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
18530 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
18532 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
18533 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
18534 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
18535 do put them in the right order. */
18537 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
18538 if (child)
18539 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
18540 else
18541 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
18544 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
18545 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
18547 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
18548 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
18549 continue;
18551 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
18552 if (child)
18553 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
18554 else
18555 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
18559 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
18560 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
18561 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
18563 static void
18564 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
18565 enum debug_info_usage usage)
18567 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18568 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
18569 int nested = 0;
18570 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
18571 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18572 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
18573 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
18574 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
18576 if (type_die && ! complete)
18577 return;
18579 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
18580 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
18581 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
18582 nested = 1;
18584 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
18586 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
18587 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
18589 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
18591 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
18592 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
18593 scope_die, type);
18594 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
18595 if (old_die)
18596 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
18597 else
18598 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
18600 else
18601 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18603 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
18604 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
18605 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (type))
18606 gen_generic_params_dies (type);
18608 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
18609 then give a list of members. */
18610 if (complete && !ns_decl)
18612 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
18613 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
18614 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18615 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
18616 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
18617 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18619 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
18620 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
18621 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
18622 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
18624 push_decl_scope (type);
18625 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
18626 pop_decl_scope ();
18628 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
18629 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
18631 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
18633 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
18634 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18635 lookup_type_die (vtype));
18638 else
18640 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18642 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
18643 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18644 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
18645 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
18648 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18649 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
18652 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
18654 static void
18655 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18657 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
18658 dw_die_ref subr_die
18659 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
18660 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18662 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
18663 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
18664 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
18665 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
18667 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
18668 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
18671 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
18673 static void
18674 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18676 dw_die_ref type_die;
18677 tree origin;
18679 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
18680 return;
18682 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
18683 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
18684 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18685 if (origin != NULL)
18686 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
18687 else
18689 tree type;
18691 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
18692 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
18694 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
18696 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
18697 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
18699 else
18700 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18702 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
18703 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
18706 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18707 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
18709 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18710 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
18713 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
18715 static void
18716 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
18717 enum debug_info_usage usage)
18719 int need_pop;
18720 struct array_descr_info info;
18722 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
18723 return;
18725 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
18726 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
18727 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
18728 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
18730 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18731 return;
18733 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
18734 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
18736 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
18737 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
18738 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
18739 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
18740 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
18742 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18743 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
18744 return;
18747 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
18748 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
18749 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info
18750 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info)
18751 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18753 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
18754 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18755 return;
18758 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
18759 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
18760 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
18761 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
18762 cloned type itself). */
18763 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
18764 type = type_main_variant (type);
18766 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18767 return;
18769 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
18771 case ERROR_MARK:
18772 break;
18774 case POINTER_TYPE:
18775 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
18776 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
18777 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
18778 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
18779 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
18780 statement. */
18781 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18783 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
18784 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
18785 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18786 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18787 break;
18789 case OFFSET_TYPE:
18790 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
18791 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
18792 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
18793 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18795 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
18796 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18797 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18799 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
18800 itself. */
18801 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
18802 break;
18804 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
18805 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
18806 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18807 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18808 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
18809 break;
18811 case METHOD_TYPE:
18812 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
18813 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18814 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18815 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
18816 break;
18818 case ARRAY_TYPE:
18819 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
18820 break;
18822 case VECTOR_TYPE:
18823 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
18824 break;
18826 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
18827 case RECORD_TYPE:
18828 case UNION_TYPE:
18829 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
18830 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
18831 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
18832 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
18833 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
18834 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
18835 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
18836 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
18837 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
18838 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
18840 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
18842 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18843 return;
18845 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
18846 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18847 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18848 need_pop = 1;
18850 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
18851 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
18853 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
18854 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
18855 decls_for_scope. */
18856 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18857 need_pop = 0;
18859 else
18861 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
18862 need_pop = 0;
18865 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
18867 /* This might have been written out by the call to
18868 declare_in_namespace. */
18869 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18870 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
18872 else
18873 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
18875 if (need_pop)
18876 pop_decl_scope ();
18878 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
18879 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
18880 when appropriate. */
18881 return;
18883 case VOID_TYPE:
18884 case INTEGER_TYPE:
18885 case REAL_TYPE:
18886 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
18887 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
18888 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
18889 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
18890 break;
18892 case LANG_TYPE:
18893 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
18894 break;
18896 default:
18897 gcc_unreachable ();
18900 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18903 static void
18904 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18906 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18909 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
18910 things which are local to the given block. */
18912 static void
18913 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18915 int must_output_die = 0;
18916 bool inlined_func;
18918 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
18919 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
18920 return;
18922 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
18924 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
18925 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
18926 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
18927 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
18929 tree sub;
18931 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
18932 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
18934 return;
18937 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
18938 block. */
18939 if (inlined_func)
18940 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
18941 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
18942 must_output_die = 1;
18943 else
18945 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
18946 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
18947 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18948 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
18949 as being a "significant" one. */
18950 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
18951 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
18952 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
18953 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
18954 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
18955 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
18956 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
18957 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18958 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
18959 must_output_die = 1;
18962 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
18963 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
18964 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
18965 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
18966 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
18967 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
18968 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
18969 if (must_output_die)
18971 if (inlined_func)
18973 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
18974 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
18975 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
18976 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
18977 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
18978 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
18979 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
18980 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
18982 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
18983 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
18984 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
18985 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
18986 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18987 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
18989 else
18990 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
18992 else
18993 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
18996 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
18997 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
18998 static void
18999 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
19001 dw_die_ref die;
19002 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
19003 tree ultimate_origin = origin ? decl_ultimate_origin (origin) : NULL;
19005 if (ultimate_origin)
19006 origin = ultimate_origin;
19008 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19009 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
19010 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
19011 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
19012 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
19013 else
19014 die = NULL;
19016 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
19017 add_child_die (context_die, die);
19018 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
19019 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
19020 stmt, context_die);
19021 else
19022 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, context_die);
19025 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
19026 all of its sub-blocks. */
19028 static void
19029 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
19031 tree decl;
19032 unsigned int i;
19033 tree subblocks;
19035 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
19036 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
19037 return;
19039 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
19040 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
19041 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
19042 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
19043 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
19044 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
19045 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
19046 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
19047 context_die);
19049 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
19050 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19051 return;
19053 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
19054 therein) of this block. */
19055 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
19056 subblocks != NULL;
19057 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
19058 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
19061 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
19063 static inline int
19064 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
19066 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
19067 return 1;
19069 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
19070 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
19071 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
19072 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
19073 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
19074 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
19075 return 1;
19077 return 0;
19080 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
19082 static inline dw_die_ref
19083 get_context_die (tree context)
19085 if (context)
19087 /* Find die that represents this context. */
19088 if (TYPE_P (context))
19089 return force_type_die (context);
19090 else
19091 return force_decl_die (context);
19093 return comp_unit_die;
19096 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
19098 static dw_die_ref
19099 force_decl_die (tree decl)
19101 dw_die_ref decl_die;
19102 unsigned saved_external_flag;
19103 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
19104 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19105 if (!decl_die)
19107 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19109 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19110 if (decl_die)
19111 return decl_die;
19113 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
19115 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19116 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
19117 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
19118 declaration die. */
19119 save_fn = current_function_decl;
19120 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
19121 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
19122 current_function_decl = save_fn;
19123 break;
19125 case VAR_DECL:
19126 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
19127 gen_decl_die() call. */
19128 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
19129 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
19130 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
19131 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
19132 break;
19134 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19135 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19136 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19137 else
19138 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
19139 decl_die = comp_unit_die;
19140 break;
19142 default:
19143 gcc_unreachable ();
19146 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
19147 if (!decl_die)
19148 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19149 gcc_assert (decl_die);
19152 return decl_die;
19155 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
19156 always returned. */
19158 static dw_die_ref
19159 force_type_die (tree type)
19161 dw_die_ref type_die;
19163 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19164 if (!type_die)
19166 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
19168 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_READONLY (type),
19169 TYPE_VOLATILE (type), context_die);
19170 gcc_assert (type_die);
19172 return type_die;
19175 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
19176 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
19178 static dw_die_ref
19179 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
19181 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
19182 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
19183 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19184 /* Force out the namespace. */
19185 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
19187 return context_die;
19190 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
19191 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
19193 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
19194 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
19196 static dw_die_ref
19197 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
19199 dw_die_ref ns_context;
19201 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19202 return context_die;
19204 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
19205 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
19206 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
19207 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
19208 return context_die;
19210 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
19212 if (ns_context != context_die)
19214 if (is_fortran ())
19215 return ns_context;
19216 if (DECL_P (thing))
19217 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, ns_context);
19218 else
19219 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
19221 return context_die;
19224 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
19226 static void
19227 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19229 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
19231 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
19232 they are an alias of. */
19233 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
19235 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
19236 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
19237 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
19238 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
19239 context_die, decl);
19240 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
19241 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19243 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
19244 if (name)
19245 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
19247 else
19248 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
19249 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19250 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19251 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
19253 else
19255 /* Output a namespace alias. */
19257 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
19258 dw_die_ref origin_die
19259 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
19261 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
19262 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19263 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
19264 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
19265 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
19266 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
19267 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
19268 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
19272 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
19274 static void
19275 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
19277 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
19278 tree class_origin = NULL;
19280 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
19281 return;
19283 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
19285 case ERROR_MARK:
19286 break;
19288 case CONST_DECL:
19289 if (!is_fortran ())
19291 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
19292 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
19293 break;
19296 /* Emit its type. */
19297 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
19299 /* And its containing namespace. */
19300 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
19302 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
19303 break;
19305 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19306 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
19307 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
19308 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
19309 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
19310 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
19311 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
19312 break;
19314 #if 0
19315 /* FIXME */
19316 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
19317 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
19318 if (current_function_decl != decl)
19319 /* This is only a declaration. */;
19320 #endif
19322 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
19323 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
19324 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin ? origin : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
19326 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
19327 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
19328 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
19329 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
19330 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
19331 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
19332 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
19333 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
19334 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19336 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
19337 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
19340 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
19341 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19343 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
19344 have described its return type. */
19345 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
19347 /* And its virtual context. */
19348 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19349 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
19351 /* And its containing type. */
19352 if (!origin)
19353 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
19354 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
19355 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
19357 /* And its containing namespace. */
19358 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
19361 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
19362 if (decl)
19363 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
19364 break;
19366 case TYPE_DECL:
19367 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19368 actual typedefs. */
19369 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19370 break;
19372 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
19373 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
19374 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
19375 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
19376 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
19377 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
19378 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
19379 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
19380 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
19381 case. */
19382 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19383 break;
19385 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
19386 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
19387 else
19388 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
19389 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
19390 break;
19392 case LABEL_DECL:
19393 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
19394 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
19395 break;
19397 case VAR_DECL:
19398 case RESULT_DECL:
19399 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19400 variable declarations or definitions. */
19401 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19402 break;
19404 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
19405 object. */
19406 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
19407 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
19408 else
19409 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19411 /* And its containing type. */
19412 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
19413 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
19414 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
19416 /* And its containing namespace. */
19417 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
19419 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
19420 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
19421 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
19422 function. */
19423 if (!origin)
19424 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19425 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
19426 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
19427 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19428 context_die);
19429 else
19430 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
19431 break;
19433 case FIELD_DECL:
19434 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
19435 anonymous unions and structs. */
19436 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
19437 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
19438 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
19440 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
19441 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
19443 break;
19445 case PARM_DECL:
19446 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
19447 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
19448 else
19449 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19450 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
19451 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19452 context_die);
19453 break;
19455 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19456 case IMPORTED_DECL:
19457 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19458 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
19459 break;
19461 default:
19462 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
19463 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
19464 break;
19468 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
19469 compilation proper has finished. */
19471 static void
19472 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
19474 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
19475 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which
19476 had no corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations
19477 and definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
19478 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19479 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19482 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
19483 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
19484 static void
19485 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
19487 if (!local)
19488 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19491 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
19492 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
19493 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
19494 that DECL belongs to.
19495 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
19496 static void
19497 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
19498 tree name,
19499 tree lexical_block,
19500 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
19502 expanded_location xloc;
19503 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
19504 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
19506 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
19508 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
19509 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
19510 gcc_assert (decl);
19512 else
19513 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
19515 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
19517 if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19518 at_import_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19519 else
19520 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19521 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
19522 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
19523 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
19524 if (!at_import_die)
19526 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
19527 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
19528 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19529 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
19532 else
19534 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19535 if (!at_import_die)
19537 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
19538 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
19539 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
19541 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
19543 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
19544 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
19545 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
19546 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19547 return;
19548 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
19549 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
19551 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
19555 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19557 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19558 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
19559 lexical_block_die,
19560 lexical_block);
19561 else
19562 return;
19564 else
19565 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
19566 lexical_block_die,
19567 lexical_block);
19569 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
19570 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
19571 if (name)
19572 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
19573 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
19574 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
19577 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
19578 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
19579 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
19580 importing whole module. */
19582 static void
19583 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
19584 bool child)
19586 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
19587 dw_die_ref scope_die;
19589 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19590 return;
19592 gcc_assert (decl);
19594 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
19595 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
19596 itself. */
19598 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
19599 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
19600 if (context
19601 && TYPE_P (context)
19602 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19603 return;
19605 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19606 return;
19608 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
19610 if (child)
19612 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
19613 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
19614 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
19615 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
19618 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
19619 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
19623 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
19625 void
19626 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
19628 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
19630 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
19632 case ERROR_MARK:
19633 return;
19635 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19636 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
19637 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
19638 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
19639 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
19640 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
19641 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
19642 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
19643 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
19644 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
19645 with the definition of the function.
19647 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
19648 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
19649 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
19650 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
19651 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
19652 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
19653 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
19654 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
19655 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
19656 that they *are* definitions).
19658 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
19659 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
19660 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
19661 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
19662 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
19663 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
19664 return;
19666 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
19667 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
19668 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
19669 if (decl_function_context (decl)
19670 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
19671 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19672 context_die = NULL;
19673 break;
19675 case VAR_DECL:
19676 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
19677 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
19678 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
19679 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
19680 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
19681 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
19682 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
19683 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
19684 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
19685 return;
19687 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
19688 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
19689 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19691 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19692 variable declarations or definitions. */
19693 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19694 return;
19695 break;
19697 case CONST_DECL:
19698 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19699 return;
19700 if (!is_fortran ())
19701 return;
19702 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
19703 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19704 break;
19706 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19707 case IMPORTED_DECL:
19708 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19709 return;
19710 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
19711 return;
19712 break;
19714 case TYPE_DECL:
19715 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
19716 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
19717 return;
19719 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
19720 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
19721 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
19723 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
19724 comparisons have. */
19725 if (is_cxx ()
19726 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
19727 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
19728 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
19730 return;
19733 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
19734 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19735 return;
19737 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
19738 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
19739 if (decl_function_context (decl))
19740 context_die = NULL;
19742 break;
19744 default:
19745 return;
19748 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
19751 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
19752 a lexical block. */
19754 static void
19755 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
19756 unsigned int blocknum)
19758 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
19759 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
19762 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
19763 lexical block. */
19765 static void
19766 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
19768 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
19769 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
19772 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
19773 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
19775 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
19776 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
19777 we may end up calling them anyway. */
19779 static bool
19780 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
19782 tree decl;
19783 unsigned int i;
19785 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
19786 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
19787 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
19788 return 0;
19789 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
19791 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
19792 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
19793 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
19794 return 0;
19797 return 1;
19800 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
19802 static int
19803 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
19805 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p1 =
19806 (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p1_p;
19807 const char *const p2 = (const char *) p2_p;
19808 return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
19811 static hashval_t
19812 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
19814 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p = (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p_p;
19815 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
19818 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
19819 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
19820 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
19821 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
19822 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
19823 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
19824 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
19825 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
19826 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
19827 all searches. */
19829 static struct dwarf_file_data *
19830 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
19832 void ** slot;
19833 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
19835 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
19836 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
19837 if (file_table_last_lookup
19838 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
19839 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
19840 return file_table_last_lookup;
19842 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
19843 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
19844 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
19845 if (*slot)
19846 return (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
19848 created = GGC_NEW (struct dwarf_file_data);
19849 created->filename = file_name;
19850 created->emitted_number = 0;
19851 *slot = created;
19852 return created;
19855 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
19856 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
19857 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
19858 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
19859 types, which may include filenames. */
19861 static int
19862 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
19864 if (! fd->emitted_number)
19866 if (last_emitted_file)
19867 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
19868 else
19869 fd->emitted_number = 1;
19870 last_emitted_file = fd;
19872 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
19874 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
19875 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
19876 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
19877 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
19881 return fd->emitted_number;
19884 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
19885 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
19886 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
19888 static void
19889 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
19891 die_arg_entry entry;
19893 if (!die || !arg)
19894 return;
19896 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
19897 tmpl_value_parm_die_table
19898 = VEC_alloc (die_arg_entry, gc, 32);
19900 entry.die = die;
19901 entry.arg = arg;
19902 VEC_safe_push (die_arg_entry, gc,
19903 tmpl_value_parm_die_table,
19904 &entry);
19907 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
19908 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
19909 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
19911 static void
19912 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
19914 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
19916 unsigned i;
19917 die_arg_entry *e;
19919 for (i = 0;
19920 VEC_iterate (die_arg_entry, tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e);
19921 i++)
19922 tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg);
19927 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
19929 static void
19930 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
19932 dw_die_ref die;
19933 dw_attr_ref attr;
19934 const char *dname;
19936 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
19937 if (!die)
19938 return;
19940 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
19941 if (!dname)
19942 return;
19944 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
19945 if (attr)
19947 struct indirect_string_node *node;
19949 node = find_AT_string (dname);
19950 /* replace the string. */
19951 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
19954 else
19955 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
19958 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a direct function call.
19959 Make an entry into the direct call table, recording the point of call
19960 and a reference to the target function's debug entry. */
19962 static void
19963 dwarf2out_direct_call (tree targ)
19965 dcall_entry e;
19966 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (targ);
19968 /* If this is a clone, use the abstract origin as the target. */
19969 if (origin)
19970 targ = origin;
19972 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
19973 e.poc_decl = current_function_decl;
19974 e.targ_die = force_decl_die (targ);
19975 VEC_safe_push (dcall_entry, gc, dcall_table, &e);
19977 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
19978 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
19981 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a struct vcall_insn). */
19983 static hashval_t
19984 vcall_insn_table_hash (const void *x)
19986 return (hashval_t) ((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid;
19989 /* Return nonzero if insn_uid of struct vcall_insn *X is the same as
19990 insnd_uid of *Y. */
19992 static int
19993 vcall_insn_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
19995 return (((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid
19996 == ((const struct vcall_insn *) y)->insn_uid);
19999 /* Called when lowering indirect calls to RTL. We make a note of INSN_UID
20000 and the OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN from ADDR. For C++ virtual calls, the token
20001 is the vtable slot index that we will need to put in the virtual call
20002 table later. */
20004 static void
20005 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree addr, int insn_uid)
20007 if (is_cxx() && TREE_CODE (addr) == OBJ_TYPE_REF)
20009 tree token = OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (addr);
20010 if (TREE_CODE (token) == INTEGER_CST)
20012 struct vcall_insn *item = GGC_NEW (struct vcall_insn);
20013 struct vcall_insn **slot;
20015 gcc_assert (item);
20016 item->insn_uid = insn_uid;
20017 item->vtable_slot = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (token);
20018 slot = (struct vcall_insn **)
20019 htab_find_slot_with_hash (vcall_insn_table, &item,
20020 (hashval_t) insn_uid, INSERT);
20021 *slot = item;
20026 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a virtual function call.
20027 Make an entry into the virtual call table, recording the point of call
20028 and the slot index of the vtable entry used to call the virtual member
20029 function. The slot index was associated with the INSN_UID during the
20030 lowering to RTL. */
20032 static void
20033 dwarf2out_virtual_call (int insn_uid)
20035 vcall_entry e;
20036 struct vcall_insn item;
20037 struct vcall_insn *p;
20039 item.insn_uid = insn_uid;
20040 item.vtable_slot = 0;
20041 p = (struct vcall_insn *) htab_find_with_hash (vcall_insn_table,
20042 (void *) &item,
20043 (hashval_t) insn_uid);
20044 if (p == NULL)
20045 return;
20047 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
20048 e.vtable_slot = p->vtable_slot;
20049 VEC_safe_push (vcall_entry, gc, vcall_table, &e);
20051 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
20052 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
20055 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
20056 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
20057 our lookup table. */
20059 static void
20060 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
20062 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
20063 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
20064 rtx next_real;
20065 static const char *last_label;
20066 static const char *last_postcall_label;
20067 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
20068 tree decl;
20070 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
20071 return;
20073 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
20074 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
20075 don't do anything. */
20076 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
20077 return;
20079 newloc = GGC_CNEW (struct var_loc_node);
20080 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
20081 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. */
20082 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
20083 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
20084 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
20086 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
20087 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
20088 loclabel_num++;
20089 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
20090 last_postcall_label = NULL;
20092 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
20093 newloc->next = NULL;
20095 if (!NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
20096 newloc->label = last_label;
20097 else
20099 if (!last_postcall_label)
20101 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
20102 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
20104 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
20107 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
20108 newloc->section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
20109 else
20110 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
20112 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
20113 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
20114 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
20115 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
20118 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
20119 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
20120 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
20121 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
20123 static void
20124 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
20126 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
20128 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
20129 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
20131 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
20134 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
20135 and record information relating to this source line, in
20136 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
20138 static void
20139 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
20140 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
20142 static bool last_is_stmt = true;
20144 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
20145 && line != 0)
20147 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
20149 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
20151 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
20152 if (flag_debug_asm)
20153 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
20154 filename, line);
20156 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
20158 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
20159 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0", file_num, line);
20160 if (is_stmt != last_is_stmt)
20162 fprintf (asm_out_file, " is_stmt %d", is_stmt ? 1 : 0);
20163 last_is_stmt = is_stmt;
20165 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
20166 fprintf (asm_out_file, " discriminator %d", discriminator);
20167 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
20169 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
20170 line_info_table_in_use++;
20172 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
20174 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
20175 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
20176 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
20177 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
20179 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
20180 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
20181 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
20183 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20184 separate_line_info_table
20185 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_separate_line_info_entry,
20186 separate_line_info_table,
20187 separate_line_info_table_allocated);
20188 memset (separate_line_info_table
20189 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
20191 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
20192 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
20195 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
20196 line_info
20197 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
20198 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
20199 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
20200 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
20202 else
20204 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
20206 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
20207 line_info_table_in_use);
20209 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
20210 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
20212 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20213 line_info_table
20214 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_line_info_entry, line_info_table,
20215 line_info_table_allocated);
20216 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
20217 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
20220 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
20221 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
20222 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
20223 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
20228 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
20230 static void
20231 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
20233 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
20235 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
20236 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
20238 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
20239 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
20242 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20244 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
20246 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20247 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
20248 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
20249 lineno);
20251 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
20255 /* Record the end of a source file. */
20257 static void
20258 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20260 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
20261 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
20262 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
20264 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20266 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20267 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
20271 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
20272 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
20273 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
20275 static void
20276 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
20277 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20279 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20281 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20282 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
20283 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
20284 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
20288 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
20289 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
20290 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
20292 static void
20293 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
20294 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20296 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20298 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20299 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
20300 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
20301 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
20305 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
20307 static void
20308 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20310 /* Allocate the file_table. */
20311 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
20312 file_table_eq, NULL);
20314 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
20315 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
20316 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
20318 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
20319 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
20320 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
20322 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
20323 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
20325 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
20326 abbrev_die_table = GGC_CNEWVEC (dw_die_ref, ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
20327 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20328 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
20329 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
20331 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
20332 line_info_table = GGC_CNEWVEC (dw_line_info_entry, LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT);
20333 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20335 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
20336 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
20338 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
20339 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
20340 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
20342 /* Allocate the table that maps insn UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
20343 vcall_insn_table = htab_create_ggc (10, vcall_insn_table_hash,
20344 vcall_insn_table_eq, NULL);
20346 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
20347 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
20348 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
20349 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
20350 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
20351 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
20352 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
20354 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
20356 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
20358 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
20359 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20360 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
20361 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20362 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
20363 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20364 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
20365 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20366 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
20367 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20368 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
20369 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20370 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
20371 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20372 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
20373 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20374 debug_dcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION,
20375 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20376 debug_vcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION,
20377 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20378 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
20379 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
20380 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
20381 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20382 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
20383 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20385 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
20386 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
20387 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20388 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20389 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
20390 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20391 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
20393 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
20394 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20395 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
20396 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20397 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
20398 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20399 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
20400 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
20401 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
20402 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
20403 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
20404 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
20406 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20408 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20409 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
20410 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20411 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
20414 switch_to_section (text_section);
20415 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
20416 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
20418 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
20419 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
20420 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
20425 /* Called before cgraph_optimize starts outputtting functions, variables
20426 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
20428 static void
20429 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
20431 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
20433 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
20434 if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS || (!flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions))
20435 #endif
20436 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
20440 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
20441 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
20443 static int
20444 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20446 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
20448 if (node->label && node->refcount)
20450 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
20451 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
20452 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
20455 return 1;
20458 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
20459 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
20461 static void
20462 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
20464 dw_die_ref c;
20466 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
20467 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
20469 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
20471 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
20472 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
20474 static void
20475 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
20477 dw_die_ref c;
20479 if (die->die_mark)
20480 die->die_mark = 0;
20481 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
20484 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
20485 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
20487 static void
20488 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
20490 dw_attr_ref a;
20491 unsigned ix;
20493 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
20495 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
20497 /* A reference to another DIE.
20498 Make sure that it will get emitted.
20499 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
20500 if (dwarf_version < 4
20501 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
20502 || a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die->die_id.die_type_node == NULL)
20503 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
20505 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
20506 accounts properly for it. */
20507 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
20508 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
20513 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
20514 to DIE's children. */
20516 static void
20517 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
20519 dw_die_ref c;
20521 if (die->die_mark == 0)
20523 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
20524 die->die_mark = 1;
20526 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
20527 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
20528 if (die->die_parent)
20529 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
20531 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
20532 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
20534 /* If this node is a specification,
20535 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
20536 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
20537 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
20540 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
20542 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
20543 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
20544 die->die_mark = 2;
20546 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
20547 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
20548 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
20549 for all type definitions. */
20550 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
20551 || (dwarf_version >= 4
20552 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
20553 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
20554 else
20555 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
20559 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
20560 and if so, mark them. */
20562 static void
20563 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
20565 dw_die_ref c;
20567 if (die->die_mark == 2)
20568 return;
20570 switch (die->die_tag)
20572 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
20573 case DW_TAG_union_type:
20574 case DW_TAG_class_type:
20575 break;
20577 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
20578 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
20579 || die->die_definition != NULL)
20580 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
20581 return;
20583 default:
20584 return;
20587 /* Mark children. */
20588 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
20591 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
20593 static void
20594 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
20596 dw_die_ref c;
20598 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
20599 children have been marked as well. */
20600 if (die->die_mark == 2)
20601 return;
20603 switch (die->die_tag)
20605 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
20606 case DW_TAG_union_type:
20607 case DW_TAG_class_type:
20608 if (die->die_perennial_p)
20609 break;
20611 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
20612 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
20613 break;
20615 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
20616 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
20617 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
20618 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
20619 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
20620 if (c)
20621 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
20623 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
20624 return;
20626 case DW_TAG_const_type:
20627 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
20628 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
20629 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
20630 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
20631 case DW_TAG_typedef:
20632 case DW_TAG_array_type:
20633 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
20634 case DW_TAG_friend:
20635 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
20636 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
20637 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
20638 case DW_TAG_string_type:
20639 case DW_TAG_set_type:
20640 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
20641 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
20642 case DW_TAG_file_type:
20643 if (die->die_perennial_p)
20644 break;
20646 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
20647 return;
20649 default:
20650 /* Mark everything else. */
20651 break;
20654 if (die->die_mark == 0)
20656 die->die_mark = 1;
20658 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
20659 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
20662 die->die_mark = 2;
20664 /* Mark children. */
20665 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
20668 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
20669 attributes. */
20671 static void
20672 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
20674 dw_attr_ref a;
20675 unsigned ix;
20677 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
20678 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
20680 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
20681 s->refcount++;
20682 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
20683 twice in the hash table. */
20684 if (s->refcount
20685 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
20687 void ** slot;
20688 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
20689 htab_hash_string (s->str),
20690 INSERT);
20691 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
20692 *slot = s;
20697 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
20699 static void
20700 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
20702 dw_die_ref c;
20704 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
20705 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
20707 if (! die->die_child)
20708 return;
20710 c = die->die_child;
20711 do {
20712 dw_die_ref prev = c;
20713 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
20714 if (c == die->die_child)
20716 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
20717 if (prev == c)
20718 /* No marked children at all. */
20719 die->die_child = NULL;
20720 else
20722 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
20723 die->die_child = prev;
20725 return;
20728 if (c != prev->die_sib)
20729 prev->die_sib = c;
20730 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
20731 } while (c != die->die_child);
20734 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
20735 htab_traverse. Clear .debug_str strings that we haven't already
20736 decided to emit. */
20738 static int
20739 prune_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20741 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
20743 if (!node->label || !node->refcount)
20744 htab_clear_slot (debug_str_hash, h);
20746 return 1;
20749 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
20751 static void
20752 prune_unused_types (void)
20754 unsigned int i;
20755 limbo_die_node *node;
20756 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
20757 pubname_ref pub;
20758 dcall_entry *dcall;
20760 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
20761 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
20762 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
20763 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20764 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
20765 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20766 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
20767 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
20769 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
20770 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
20772 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
20773 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
20774 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20775 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
20776 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20778 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
20779 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
20782 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
20783 pubname_table or arange_table. */
20784 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
20785 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
20786 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
20787 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
20789 /* Mark nodes referenced from the direct call table. */
20790 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, dcall); i++)
20791 prune_unused_types_mark (dcall->targ_die, 1);
20793 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
20794 if (debug_str_hash && debug_str_hash_forced)
20795 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, prune_indirect_string, NULL);
20796 else if (debug_str_hash)
20797 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
20798 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
20799 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20800 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
20801 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20802 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
20804 /* Leave the marks clear. */
20805 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
20806 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20807 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
20808 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20809 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
20812 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
20813 the file table. */
20814 static int
20815 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
20817 bool *p = (bool *) param;
20818 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
20819 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
20821 *p = true;
20822 return 0;
20824 return 1;
20827 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
20829 static hashval_t
20830 htab_ct_hash (const void *of)
20832 hashval_t h;
20833 const comdat_type_node *const type_node = (const comdat_type_node *) of;
20835 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
20836 return h;
20839 static int
20840 htab_ct_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
20842 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_1 = (const comdat_type_node *) of1;
20843 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_2 = (const comdat_type_node *) of2;
20845 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
20846 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
20849 /* Move a DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
20850 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
20851 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
20852 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
20853 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
20854 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
20856 static inline void
20857 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
20859 unsigned ix = VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
20860 dw_attr_node linkage = *VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
20862 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
20864 while (--ix > 0)
20866 dw_attr_node *prev = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
20868 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
20869 break;
20872 if (ix != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr) - 1)
20874 VEC_pop (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
20875 VEC_quick_insert (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, &linkage);
20879 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
20880 one CONST_STRING, return non-zero if not successful. Similarly verify that
20881 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
20883 static int
20884 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20886 rtx rtl = *addr;
20888 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
20890 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
20891 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
20892 tree tlen = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, len - 1);
20893 TREE_TYPE (t)
20894 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
20895 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
20896 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
20897 return 1;
20898 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
20899 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
20900 *addr = rtl;
20901 return 0;
20904 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
20905 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
20906 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
20907 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
20908 return 1;
20910 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
20911 && for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), resolve_one_addr, NULL))
20912 return 1;
20914 return 0;
20917 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
20918 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
20919 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
20921 static bool
20922 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
20924 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
20925 if ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
20926 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
20927 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_implicit_value
20928 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
20929 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr, NULL)))
20930 return false;
20931 return true;
20934 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
20935 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
20936 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
20937 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
20938 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
20939 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
20941 static void
20942 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
20944 dw_die_ref c;
20945 dw_attr_ref a;
20946 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
20947 unsigned ix;
20949 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
20950 switch (AT_class (a))
20952 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
20953 for (curr = AT_loc_list (a); curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
20954 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (curr->expr))
20955 curr->expr = NULL;
20956 break;
20957 case dw_val_class_loc:
20958 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (AT_loc (a)))
20959 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = NULL;
20960 break;
20961 case dw_val_class_addr:
20962 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
20963 && resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr, NULL))
20965 a->dw_attr = DW_AT_location;
20966 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
20967 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = NULL;
20969 break;
20970 default:
20971 break;
20974 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
20977 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
20978 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
20980 static void
20981 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
20983 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
20984 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
20985 htab_t comdat_type_table;
20986 dw_die_ref die = 0;
20987 unsigned int i;
20989 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
20991 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
20992 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
20993 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, remap_debug_filename (filename));
20994 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename))
20995 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
20996 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
20998 bool p = false;
20999 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
21000 if (p)
21001 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
21004 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list); i++)
21006 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (
21007 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->die,
21008 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->variable,
21009 DW_AT_location);
21012 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
21013 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
21014 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
21015 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
21016 instance. */
21017 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
21019 next_node = node->next;
21020 die = node->die;
21022 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
21024 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
21026 if (origin)
21027 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
21028 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
21030 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
21031 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
21032 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
21033 else
21035 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
21036 nested function can be optimized away, which results
21037 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
21038 with the return type of that nested function. Force
21039 this to be a child of the containing function.
21041 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
21042 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
21043 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
21044 the function is likely unreachable too. */
21045 tree context = NULL_TREE;
21047 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
21049 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
21050 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
21051 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
21052 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
21054 gcc_assert (context
21055 && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
21056 || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
21058 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
21059 if (origin)
21060 add_child_die (origin, die);
21061 else
21062 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
21067 limbo_die_list = NULL;
21069 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die);
21071 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
21073 tree decl = node->created_for;
21074 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
21076 add_AT_string (node->die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
21077 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
21078 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
21082 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
21084 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
21085 emit full debugging info for them. */
21086 retry_incomplete_types ();
21088 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
21089 prune_unused_types ();
21091 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
21092 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
21093 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
21094 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
21096 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
21097 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
21099 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die);
21101 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
21102 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
21103 limbo die list. */
21104 limbo_die_list = NULL;
21106 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
21107 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
21108 references to the main compile unit). */
21109 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21110 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
21111 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die);
21113 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
21114 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
21115 referenced. Prune them. */
21116 prune_unused_types ();
21119 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
21120 that have children. */
21121 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
21122 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21123 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
21124 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21125 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
21127 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
21128 switch_to_section (text_section);
21129 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
21130 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
21132 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
21133 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
21136 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
21137 in .text. */
21138 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
21139 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
21141 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
21142 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
21145 else
21147 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
21149 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
21150 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
21151 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
21152 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
21153 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
21154 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx);
21155 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
21157 add_AT_range_list (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_ranges,
21158 add_ranges_by_labels (text_section_label,
21159 text_end_label));
21160 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
21161 add_ranges_by_labels (cold_text_section_label,
21162 cold_end_label);
21164 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
21166 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
21168 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
21170 if (!fde->in_std_section)
21171 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
21172 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label);
21173 if (!fde->cold_in_std_section)
21174 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
21175 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label);
21177 else if (!fde->in_std_section)
21178 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_begin,
21179 fde->dw_fde_end);
21182 add_ranges (NULL);
21185 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
21186 if (have_location_lists)
21188 /* Output the location lists info. */
21189 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
21190 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
21191 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21192 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
21193 output_location_lists (die);
21196 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
21197 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
21198 debug_line_section_label);
21200 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21201 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
21203 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
21204 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
21205 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21206 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
21208 comdat_type_table = htab_create (100, htab_ct_hash, htab_ct_eq, NULL);
21209 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21211 void **slot = htab_find_slot (comdat_type_table, ctnode, INSERT);
21213 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
21214 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
21215 continue;
21217 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
21218 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
21219 attributes. */
21220 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
21221 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
21222 debug_line_section_label);
21224 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
21225 *slot = ctnode;
21227 htab_delete (comdat_type_table);
21229 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
21230 has been emitted. */
21231 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE);
21233 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
21234 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
21235 output_abbrev_section ();
21237 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
21238 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
21240 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
21241 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
21244 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
21245 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
21246 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
21247 simply won't look for the section. */
21248 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
21250 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
21251 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
21254 /* Output direct and virtual call tables if necessary. */
21255 if (!VEC_empty (dcall_entry, dcall_table))
21257 switch_to_section (debug_dcall_section);
21258 output_dcall_table ();
21260 if (!VEC_empty (vcall_entry, vcall_table))
21262 switch_to_section (debug_vcall_section);
21263 output_vcall_table ();
21266 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
21267 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
21268 if (fde_table_in_use)
21270 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
21271 output_aranges ();
21274 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
21275 if (ranges_table_in_use)
21277 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
21278 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
21279 output_ranges ();
21282 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
21283 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
21284 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
21285 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
21286 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
21287 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
21288 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21290 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
21291 output_line_info ();
21294 /* Have to end the macro section. */
21295 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21297 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21298 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
21301 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
21302 table too. */
21303 if (debug_str_hash)
21304 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
21306 #else
21308 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
21309 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
21311 0, /* init */
21312 0, /* finish */
21313 0, /* assembly_start */
21314 0, /* define */
21315 0, /* undef */
21316 0, /* start_source_file */
21317 0, /* end_source_file */
21318 0, /* begin_block */
21319 0, /* end_block */
21320 0, /* ignore_block */
21321 0, /* source_line */
21322 0, /* begin_prologue */
21323 0, /* end_prologue */
21324 0, /* end_epilogue */
21325 0, /* begin_function */
21326 0, /* end_function */
21327 0, /* function_decl */
21328 0, /* global_decl */
21329 0, /* type_decl */
21330 0, /* imported_module_or_decl */
21331 0, /* deferred_inline_function */
21332 0, /* outlining_inline_function */
21333 0, /* label */
21334 0, /* handle_pch */
21335 0, /* var_location */
21336 0, /* switch_text_section */
21337 0, /* direct_call */
21338 0, /* virtual_call_token */
21339 0, /* virtual_call */
21340 0, /* set_name */
21341 0 /* start_end_main_source_file */
21344 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
21346 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"